|
1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files. |
|
2 % |
|
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex. |
|
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi |
|
5 % |
|
6 \def\texinfoversion{2003-07-28.08} |
|
7 % |
|
8 % Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, |
|
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
|
10 % |
|
11 % This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or |
|
12 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as |
|
13 % published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at |
|
14 % your option) any later version. |
|
15 % |
|
16 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be |
|
17 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty |
|
18 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU |
|
19 % General Public License for more details. |
|
20 % |
|
21 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License |
|
22 % along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write |
|
23 % to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, |
|
24 % Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. |
|
25 % |
|
26 % In other words, you are welcome to use, share and improve this program. |
|
27 % You are forbidden to forbid anyone else to use, share and improve |
|
28 % what you give them. Help stamp out software-hoarding! |
|
29 % |
|
30 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug |
|
31 % reports; you can get the latest version from: |
|
32 % ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/texinfo.tex |
|
33 % (and all GNU mirrors, see http://www.gnu.org/order/ftp.html) |
|
34 % ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex |
|
35 % (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org), |
|
36 % and /home/gd/gnu/doc/texinfo.tex on the GNU machines. |
|
37 % |
|
38 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo. |
|
39 % |
|
40 % The texinfo.tex in any given Texinfo distribution could well be out |
|
41 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check. |
|
42 % |
|
43 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a |
|
44 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the |
|
45 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated. |
|
46 % |
|
47 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the |
|
48 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple |
|
49 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this: |
|
50 % tex foo.texi |
|
51 % texindex foo.?? |
|
52 % tex foo.texi |
|
53 % tex foo.texi |
|
54 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps. |
|
55 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct. |
|
56 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more |
|
57 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary. |
|
58 % |
|
59 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some |
|
60 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the |
|
61 % full Texinfo distribution. |
|
62 |
|
63 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:} |
|
64 |
|
65 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number |
|
66 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because |
|
67 % they might have appeared in the input file name. |
|
68 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}% |
|
69 \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active} |
|
70 |
|
71 \message{Basics,} |
|
72 \chardef\other=12 |
|
73 |
|
74 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo. |
|
75 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign. |
|
76 \let\+ = \relax |
|
77 |
|
78 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine. |
|
79 \let\ptexb=\b |
|
80 \let\ptexbullet=\bullet |
|
81 \let\ptexc=\c |
|
82 \let\ptexcomma=\, |
|
83 \let\ptexdot=\. |
|
84 \let\ptexdots=\dots |
|
85 \let\ptexend=\end |
|
86 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv |
|
87 \let\ptexexclam=\! |
|
88 \let\ptexgtr=> |
|
89 \let\ptexhat=^ |
|
90 \let\ptexi=\i |
|
91 \let\ptexindent=\indent |
|
92 \let\ptexlbrace=\{ |
|
93 \let\ptexless=< |
|
94 \let\ptexplus=+ |
|
95 \let\ptexrbrace=\} |
|
96 \let\ptexslash=\/ |
|
97 \let\ptexstar=\* |
|
98 \let\ptext=\t |
|
99 |
|
100 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it |
|
101 % starts a new line in the output. |
|
102 \newlinechar = `^^J |
|
103 |
|
104 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set. |
|
105 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi |
|
106 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi |
|
107 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi |
|
108 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi |
|
109 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi |
|
110 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi |
|
111 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi |
|
112 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi |
|
113 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi |
|
114 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi |
|
115 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi |
|
116 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi |
|
117 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi |
|
118 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi |
|
119 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi |
|
120 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi |
|
121 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi |
|
122 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi |
|
123 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi |
|
124 % |
|
125 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi |
|
126 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi |
|
127 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi |
|
128 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi |
|
129 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi |
|
130 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi |
|
131 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi |
|
132 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi |
|
133 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi |
|
134 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi |
|
135 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi |
|
136 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi |
|
137 % |
|
138 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi |
|
139 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi |
|
140 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi |
|
141 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi |
|
142 \ifx\putwordDeftypevar\undefined\gdef\putwordDeftypevar{Variable}\fi |
|
143 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi |
|
144 \ifx\putwordDeftypefun\undefined\gdef\putwordDeftypefun{Function}\fi |
|
145 |
|
146 % In some macros, we cannot use the `\? notation---the left quote is |
|
147 % in some cases the escape char. |
|
148 \chardef\colonChar = `\: |
|
149 \chardef\commaChar = `\, |
|
150 \chardef\dotChar = `\. |
|
151 \chardef\equalChar = `\= |
|
152 \chardef\exclamChar= `\! |
|
153 \chardef\questChar = `\? |
|
154 \chardef\semiChar = `\; |
|
155 \chardef\spaceChar = `\ % |
|
156 \chardef\underChar = `\_ |
|
157 |
|
158 % Ignore a token. |
|
159 % |
|
160 \def\gobble#1{} |
|
161 |
|
162 % True if #1 is the empty string, i.e., called like `\ifempty{}'. |
|
163 % |
|
164 \def\ifempty#1{\ifemptyx #1\emptymarkA\emptymarkB}% |
|
165 \def\ifemptyx#1#2\emptymarkB{\ifx #1\emptymarkA}% |
|
166 |
|
167 % Hyphenation fixes. |
|
168 \hyphenation{ap-pen-dix} |
|
169 \hyphenation{eshell} |
|
170 \hyphenation{mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers} |
|
171 \hyphenation{time-stamp} |
|
172 \hyphenation{white-space} |
|
173 |
|
174 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages. |
|
175 \newdimen\bindingoffset |
|
176 \newdimen\normaloffset |
|
177 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight |
|
178 |
|
179 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file |
|
180 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here, |
|
181 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make |
|
182 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log |
|
183 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX. |
|
184 % |
|
185 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}% |
|
186 \def\loggingall{% |
|
187 \tracingstats2 |
|
188 \tracingpages1 |
|
189 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex |
|
190 \tracingparagraphs1 |
|
191 \tracingoutput1 |
|
192 \tracingmacros2 |
|
193 \tracingrestores1 |
|
194 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen |
|
195 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging |
|
196 \tracingscantokens1 |
|
197 \tracingifs1 |
|
198 \tracinggroups1 |
|
199 \tracingnesting2 |
|
200 \tracingassigns1 |
|
201 \fi |
|
202 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex |
|
203 \errorcontextlines\maxdimen |
|
204 }% |
|
205 |
|
206 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing |
|
207 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space. |
|
208 % |
|
209 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount |
|
210 \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi} |
|
211 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount |
|
212 \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi} |
|
213 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount |
|
214 \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi} |
|
215 |
|
216 % For @cropmarks command. |
|
217 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks. |
|
218 % |
|
219 \newif\ifcropmarks |
|
220 \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue |
|
221 % |
|
222 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners. |
|
223 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986 |
|
224 % |
|
225 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines |
|
226 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc |
|
227 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt |
|
228 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in |
|
229 |
|
230 % Main output routine. |
|
231 \chardef\PAGE = 255 |
|
232 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}} |
|
233 |
|
234 \newbox\headlinebox |
|
235 \newbox\footlinebox |
|
236 |
|
237 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents |
|
238 % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself. |
|
239 \def\onepageout#1{% |
|
240 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi |
|
241 % |
|
242 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset |
|
243 \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi |
|
244 % |
|
245 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in |
|
246 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code). |
|
247 \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}% |
|
248 \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}% |
|
249 % |
|
250 {% |
|
251 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to |
|
252 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends |
|
253 % before the \shipout runs. |
|
254 % |
|
255 \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files. |
|
256 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output. |
|
257 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if |
|
258 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example. |
|
259 \shipout\vbox{% |
|
260 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page. |
|
261 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfmkdest{\the\pageno} \fi |
|
262 % |
|
263 \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup |
|
264 \hsize = \outerhsize |
|
265 \vskip-\topandbottommargin |
|
266 \vtop to0pt{% |
|
267 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}% |
|
268 \nointerlineskip |
|
269 \line{% |
|
270 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}% |
|
271 \hfill |
|
272 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}% |
|
273 }% |
|
274 \vss}% |
|
275 \vskip\topandbottommargin |
|
276 \line\bgroup |
|
277 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize. |
|
278 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi |
|
279 \vbox\bgroup |
|
280 \fi |
|
281 % |
|
282 \unvbox\headlinebox |
|
283 \pagebody{#1}% |
|
284 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt |
|
285 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty. |
|
286 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingxxx.) |
|
287 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect. |
|
288 \vskip 2\baselineskip |
|
289 \unvbox\footlinebox |
|
290 \fi |
|
291 % |
|
292 \ifcropmarks |
|
293 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup |
|
294 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup |
|
295 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill |
|
296 \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick |
|
297 \vbox to0pt{\vss |
|
298 \line{% |
|
299 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}% |
|
300 \hfill |
|
301 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}% |
|
302 }% |
|
303 \nointerlineskip |
|
304 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}% |
|
305 }% |
|
306 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause |
|
307 \fi |
|
308 }% end of \shipout\vbox |
|
309 }% end of group with \normalturnoffactive |
|
310 \advancepageno |
|
311 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi |
|
312 } |
|
313 |
|
314 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen |
|
315 |
|
316 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}} |
|
317 {\catcode`\@ =11 |
|
318 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi |
|
319 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala) |
|
320 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present |
|
321 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi |
|
322 \dimen@=\dp#1 \unvbox#1 |
|
323 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi |
|
324 \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi} |
|
325 } |
|
326 |
|
327 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are |
|
328 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize |
|
329 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986) |
|
330 % |
|
331 \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong} |
|
332 \def\nstop{\vbox |
|
333 {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}} |
|
334 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong} |
|
335 \def\nsbot{\vbox |
|
336 {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}} |
|
337 |
|
338 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of |
|
339 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a |
|
340 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument. |
|
341 % |
|
342 \def\parsearg#1{% |
|
343 \let\next = #1% |
|
344 \begingroup |
|
345 \obeylines |
|
346 \futurelet\temp\parseargx |
|
347 } |
|
348 |
|
349 % If the next token is an obeyed space (from an @example environment or |
|
350 % the like), remove it and recurse. Otherwise, we're done. |
|
351 \def\parseargx{% |
|
352 % \obeyedspace is defined far below, after the definition of \sepspaces. |
|
353 \ifx\obeyedspace\temp |
|
354 \expandafter\parseargdiscardspace |
|
355 \else |
|
356 \expandafter\parseargline |
|
357 \fi |
|
358 } |
|
359 |
|
360 % Remove a single space (as the delimiter token to the macro call). |
|
361 {\obeyspaces % |
|
362 \gdef\parseargdiscardspace {\futurelet\temp\parseargx}} |
|
363 |
|
364 {\obeylines % |
|
365 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{% |
|
366 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg. |
|
367 % |
|
368 % First remove any @c comment, then any @comment. |
|
369 % Result of each macro is put in \toks0. |
|
370 \argremovec #1\c\relax % |
|
371 \expandafter\argremovecomment \the\toks0 \comment\relax % |
|
372 % |
|
373 % Call the caller's macro, saved as \next in \parsearg. |
|
374 \expandafter\next\expandafter{\the\toks0}% |
|
375 }% |
|
376 } |
|
377 |
|
378 % Since all \c{,omment} does is throw away the argument, we can let TeX |
|
379 % do that for us. The \relax here is matched by the \relax in the call |
|
380 % in \parseargline; it could be more or less anything, its purpose is |
|
381 % just to delimit the argument to the \c. |
|
382 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\relax{\toks0 = {#1}} |
|
383 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\relax{\toks0 = {#1}} |
|
384 |
|
385 % \argremovec{,omment} might leave us with trailing spaces, though; e.g., |
|
386 % @end itemize @c foo |
|
387 % will have two active spaces as part of the argument with the |
|
388 % `itemize'. Here we remove all active spaces from #1, and assign the |
|
389 % result to \toks0. |
|
390 % |
|
391 % This loses if there are any *other* active characters besides spaces |
|
392 % in the argument -- _ ^ +, for example -- since they get expanded. |
|
393 % Fortunately, Texinfo does not define any such commands. (If it ever |
|
394 % does, the catcode of the characters in questionwill have to be changed |
|
395 % here.) But this means we cannot call \removeactivespaces as part of |
|
396 % \argremovec{,omment}, since @c uses \parsearg, and thus the argument |
|
397 % that \parsearg gets might well have any character at all in it. |
|
398 % |
|
399 \def\removeactivespaces#1{% |
|
400 \begingroup |
|
401 \ignoreactivespaces |
|
402 \edef\temp{#1}% |
|
403 \global\toks0 = \expandafter{\temp}% |
|
404 \endgroup |
|
405 } |
|
406 |
|
407 % Change the active space to expand to nothing. |
|
408 % |
|
409 \begingroup |
|
410 \obeyspaces |
|
411 \gdef\ignoreactivespaces{\obeyspaces\let =\empty} |
|
412 \endgroup |
|
413 |
|
414 |
|
415 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next} |
|
416 |
|
417 %% These are used to keep @begin/@end levels from running away |
|
418 %% Call \inENV within environments (after a \begingroup) |
|
419 \newif\ifENV \ENVfalse \def\inENV{\ifENV\relax\else\ENVtrue\fi} |
|
420 \def\ENVcheck{% |
|
421 \ifENV\errmessage{Still within an environment; press RETURN to continue} |
|
422 \endgroup\fi} % This is not perfect, but it should reduce lossage |
|
423 |
|
424 % @begin foo is the same as @foo, for now. |
|
425 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.} |
|
426 |
|
427 \outer\def\begin{\parsearg\beginxxx} |
|
428 |
|
429 \def\beginxxx #1{% |
|
430 \expandafter\ifx\csname #1\endcsname\relax |
|
431 {\errhelp=\EMsimple \errmessage{Undefined command @begin #1}}\else |
|
432 \csname #1\endcsname\fi} |
|
433 |
|
434 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo. |
|
435 % |
|
436 \def\end{\parsearg\endxxx} |
|
437 \def\endxxx #1{% |
|
438 \removeactivespaces{#1}% |
|
439 \edef\endthing{\the\toks0}% |
|
440 % |
|
441 \expandafter\ifx\csname E\endthing\endcsname\relax |
|
442 \expandafter\ifx\csname \endthing\endcsname\relax |
|
443 % There's no \foo, i.e., no ``environment'' foo. |
|
444 \errhelp = \EMsimple |
|
445 \errmessage{Undefined command `@end \endthing'}% |
|
446 \else |
|
447 \unmatchedenderror\endthing |
|
448 \fi |
|
449 \else |
|
450 % Everything's ok; the right environment has been started. |
|
451 \csname E\endthing\endcsname |
|
452 \fi |
|
453 } |
|
454 |
|
455 % There is an environment #1, but it hasn't been started. Give an error. |
|
456 % |
|
457 \def\unmatchedenderror#1{% |
|
458 \errhelp = \EMsimple |
|
459 \errmessage{This `@end #1' doesn't have a matching `@#1'}% |
|
460 } |
|
461 |
|
462 % Define the control sequence \E#1 to give an unmatched @end error. |
|
463 % |
|
464 \def\defineunmatchedend#1{% |
|
465 \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\unmatchedenderror{#1}}% |
|
466 } |
|
467 |
|
468 |
|
469 %% Simple single-character @ commands |
|
470 |
|
471 % @@ prints an @ |
|
472 % Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr). |
|
473 \def\@{{\tt\char64}} |
|
474 |
|
475 % This is turned off because it was never documented |
|
476 % and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures. |
|
477 %% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and ' |
|
478 %% but suppressing ligatures. |
|
479 %\def\`{{`}} |
|
480 %\def\'{{'}} |
|
481 |
|
482 % Used to generate quoted braces. |
|
483 \def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}} |
|
484 \def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}} |
|
485 \let\{=\mylbrace |
|
486 \let\}=\myrbrace |
|
487 \begingroup |
|
488 % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices, |
|
489 % and @{ and @} for the aux file. |
|
490 \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other |
|
491 \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2 |
|
492 \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other |
|
493 !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]% |
|
494 !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]% |
|
495 !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]% |
|
496 !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]% |
|
497 !endgroup |
|
498 |
|
499 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent |
|
500 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H. |
|
501 \let\, = \c |
|
502 \let\dotaccent = \. |
|
503 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}} |
|
504 \let\tieaccent = \t |
|
505 \let\ubaraccent = \b |
|
506 \let\udotaccent = \d |
|
507 |
|
508 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown |
|
509 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss. |
|
510 \def\questiondown{?`} |
|
511 \def\exclamdown{!`} |
|
512 |
|
513 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents. |
|
514 \def\imacro{i} |
|
515 \def\jmacro{j} |
|
516 \def\dotless#1{% |
|
517 \def\temp{#1}% |
|
518 \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi |
|
519 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j |
|
520 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}% |
|
521 \fi\fi |
|
522 } |
|
523 |
|
524 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space |
|
525 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space |
|
526 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and |
|
527 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the |
|
528 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph. |
|
529 {\catcode`@ = 11 |
|
530 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble |
|
531 % if the definition is written into an index file. |
|
532 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M |
|
533 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ } |
|
534 } |
|
535 |
|
536 % @: forces normal size whitespace following. |
|
537 \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 } |
|
538 |
|
539 % @* forces a line break. |
|
540 \def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces} |
|
541 |
|
542 % @/ allows a line break. |
|
543 \let\/=\allowbreak |
|
544 |
|
545 % @. is an end-of-sentence period. |
|
546 \def\.{.\spacefactor=3000 } |
|
547 |
|
548 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang. |
|
549 \def\!{!\spacefactor=3000 } |
|
550 |
|
551 % @? is an end-of-sentence query. |
|
552 \def\?{?\spacefactor=3000 } |
|
553 |
|
554 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the |
|
555 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would |
|
556 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph. |
|
557 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}} |
|
558 |
|
559 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing |
|
560 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box |
|
561 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for |
|
562 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is |
|
563 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large, |
|
564 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and |
|
565 % the text is small, which looks bad. |
|
566 % |
|
567 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can |
|
568 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it |
|
569 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an |
|
570 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The |
|
571 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit |
|
572 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex). |
|
573 % |
|
574 \newbox\groupbox |
|
575 \def\vfilllimit{0.7} |
|
576 % |
|
577 \def\group{\begingroup |
|
578 \ifnum\catcode13=\active \else |
|
579 \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp |
|
580 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}% |
|
581 \fi |
|
582 % |
|
583 % The \vtop we start below produces a box with normal height and large |
|
584 % depth; thus, TeX puts \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the |
|
585 % next line of text is done) \lineskip glue after it. (See p.82 of |
|
586 % the TeXbook.) Thus, space below is not quite equal to space |
|
587 % above. But it's pretty close. |
|
588 \def\Egroup{% |
|
589 \egroup % End the \vtop. |
|
590 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box. |
|
591 \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox |
|
592 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less). |
|
593 \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal |
|
594 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big |
|
595 % group, force a page break. |
|
596 \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2 |
|
597 \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight |
|
598 \page |
|
599 \fi |
|
600 \fi |
|
601 \copy\groupbox |
|
602 \endgroup % End the \group. |
|
603 }% |
|
604 % |
|
605 \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup |
|
606 % We have to put a strut on the last line in case the @group is in |
|
607 % the midst of an example, rather than completely enclosing it. |
|
608 % Otherwise, the interline space between the last line of the group |
|
609 % and the first line afterwards is too small. But we can't put the |
|
610 % strut in \Egroup, since there it would be on a line by itself. |
|
611 % Hence this just inserts a strut at the beginning of each line. |
|
612 \everypar = {\strut}% |
|
613 % |
|
614 % Since we have a strut on every line, we don't need any of TeX's |
|
615 % normal interline spacing. |
|
616 \offinterlineskip |
|
617 % |
|
618 % OK, but now we have to do something about blank |
|
619 % lines in the input in @example-like environments, which normally |
|
620 % just turn into \lisppar, which will insert no space now that we've |
|
621 % turned off the interline space. Simplest is to make them be an |
|
622 % empty paragraph. |
|
623 \ifx\par\lisppar |
|
624 \edef\par{\leavevmode \par}% |
|
625 % |
|
626 % Reset ^^M's definition to new definition of \par. |
|
627 \obeylines |
|
628 \fi |
|
629 % |
|
630 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as |
|
631 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an |
|
632 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after |
|
633 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group |
|
634 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo |
|
635 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text. |
|
636 \comment |
|
637 } |
|
638 % |
|
639 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help |
|
640 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'. |
|
641 % |
|
642 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{% |
|
643 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J% |
|
644 where each line of input produces a line of output.} |
|
645 |
|
646 % @need space-in-mils |
|
647 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining. |
|
648 |
|
649 \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in |
|
650 |
|
651 \def\need{\parsearg\needx} |
|
652 |
|
653 % Old definition--didn't work. |
|
654 %\def\needx #1{\par % |
|
655 %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally |
|
656 %% if the depth of the box does not fit. |
|
657 %{\baselineskip=0pt% |
|
658 %\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak |
|
659 %\prevdepth=-1000pt |
|
660 %}} |
|
661 |
|
662 \def\needx#1{% |
|
663 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a |
|
664 % paragraph. |
|
665 \par |
|
666 % |
|
667 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless. |
|
668 \dimen0 = #1\mil |
|
669 \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox |
|
670 \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox |
|
671 \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2 |
|
672 % |
|
673 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the |
|
674 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line. |
|
675 % And a page break here is fine. |
|
676 \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}% |
|
677 % |
|
678 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the |
|
679 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the |
|
680 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider |
|
681 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the |
|
682 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999. |
|
683 % |
|
684 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the |
|
685 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in |
|
686 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which |
|
687 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing |
|
688 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an |
|
689 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real |
|
690 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy. |
|
691 \penalty9999 |
|
692 % |
|
693 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not. |
|
694 \kern -#1\mil |
|
695 % |
|
696 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern. |
|
697 \nobreak |
|
698 \fi |
|
699 } |
|
700 |
|
701 % @br forces paragraph break |
|
702 |
|
703 \let\br = \par |
|
704 |
|
705 % @dots{} output an ellipsis using the current font. |
|
706 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in a typewriter |
|
707 % font as three actual period characters. |
|
708 % |
|
709 \def\dots{% |
|
710 \leavevmode |
|
711 \hbox to 1.5em{% |
|
712 \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil minus 0.25fil |
|
713 .\hss.\hss.% |
|
714 \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil minus 0.5fil |
|
715 }% |
|
716 } |
|
717 |
|
718 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis. |
|
719 % |
|
720 \def\enddots{% |
|
721 \leavevmode |
|
722 \hbox to 2em{% |
|
723 \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil minus 0.25fil |
|
724 .\hss.\hss.\hss.% |
|
725 \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil minus 0.5fil |
|
726 }% |
|
727 \spacefactor=3000 |
|
728 } |
|
729 |
|
730 % @page forces the start of a new page. |
|
731 % |
|
732 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject} |
|
733 |
|
734 % @exdent text.... |
|
735 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin |
|
736 |
|
737 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment. |
|
738 % That's how much \exdent should take out. |
|
739 \newskip\exdentamount |
|
740 |
|
741 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun. |
|
742 \def\exdent{\parsearg\exdentyyy} |
|
743 \def\exdentyyy #1{{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}} |
|
744 |
|
745 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example. |
|
746 \def\nofillexdent{\parsearg\nofillexdentyyy} |
|
747 \def\nofillexdentyyy #1{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount |
|
748 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}} |
|
749 |
|
750 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current |
|
751 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion |
|
752 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. |
|
753 % |
|
754 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm |
|
755 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox} |
|
756 % |
|
757 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{% |
|
758 \nobreak |
|
759 \kern-\strutdepth |
|
760 \vtop to \strutdepth{% |
|
761 \baselineskip=\strutdepth |
|
762 \vss |
|
763 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to |
|
764 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size. |
|
765 \ifx#1l% |
|
766 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}% |
|
767 \else |
|
768 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}% |
|
769 \fi |
|
770 \null |
|
771 }% |
|
772 }} |
|
773 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l} |
|
774 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r} |
|
775 % |
|
776 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]} |
|
777 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right; |
|
778 % else use TEXT for both). |
|
779 % |
|
780 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish} |
|
781 \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing. |
|
782 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% |
|
783 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt |
|
784 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts |
|
785 \def\righttext{#2}% |
|
786 \else |
|
787 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text |
|
788 \def\righttext{#1}% |
|
789 \fi |
|
790 % |
|
791 \ifodd\pageno |
|
792 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin |
|
793 \else |
|
794 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}% |
|
795 \fi |
|
796 \temp |
|
797 } |
|
798 |
|
799 % @include file insert text of that file as input. |
|
800 % Allow normal characters that we make active in the argument (a file name). |
|
801 \def\include{\begingroup |
|
802 \catcode`\\=\other |
|
803 \catcode`~=\other |
|
804 \catcode`^=\other |
|
805 \catcode`_=\other |
|
806 \catcode`|=\other |
|
807 \catcode`<=\other |
|
808 \catcode`>=\other |
|
809 \catcode`+=\other |
|
810 \parsearg\includezzz} |
|
811 % Restore active chars for included file. |
|
812 \def\includezzz#1{\endgroup\begingroup |
|
813 % Read the included file in a group so nested @include's work. |
|
814 \def\thisfile{#1}% |
|
815 \let\value=\expandablevalue |
|
816 \input\thisfile |
|
817 \endgroup} |
|
818 |
|
819 \def\thisfile{} |
|
820 |
|
821 % @center line |
|
822 % outputs that line, centered. |
|
823 % |
|
824 \def\center{\parsearg\docenter} |
|
825 \def\docenter#1{{% |
|
826 \ifhmode \hfil\break \fi |
|
827 \advance\hsize by -\leftskip |
|
828 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip |
|
829 \line{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}% |
|
830 \ifhmode \break \fi |
|
831 }} |
|
832 |
|
833 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space |
|
834 |
|
835 \def\sp{\parsearg\spxxx} |
|
836 \def\spxxx #1{\vskip #1\baselineskip} |
|
837 |
|
838 % @comment ...line which is ignored... |
|
839 % @c is the same as @comment |
|
840 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment |
|
841 |
|
842 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other% |
|
843 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other% |
|
844 \commentxxx} |
|
845 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}} |
|
846 |
|
847 \let\c=\comment |
|
848 |
|
849 % @paragraphindent NCHARS |
|
850 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough. |
|
851 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'. |
|
852 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though. |
|
853 % |
|
854 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords |
|
855 \def\noneword{none} |
|
856 % |
|
857 \def\paragraphindent{\parsearg\doparagraphindent} |
|
858 \def\doparagraphindent#1{% |
|
859 \def\temp{#1}% |
|
860 \ifx\temp\asisword |
|
861 \else |
|
862 \ifx\temp\noneword |
|
863 \defaultparindent = 0pt |
|
864 \else |
|
865 \defaultparindent = #1em |
|
866 \fi |
|
867 \fi |
|
868 \parindent = \defaultparindent |
|
869 } |
|
870 |
|
871 % @exampleindent NCHARS |
|
872 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent. |
|
873 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but |
|
874 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent. |
|
875 \def\exampleindent{\parsearg\doexampleindent} |
|
876 \def\doexampleindent#1{% |
|
877 \def\temp{#1}% |
|
878 \ifx\temp\asisword |
|
879 \else |
|
880 \ifx\temp\noneword |
|
881 \lispnarrowing = 0pt |
|
882 \else |
|
883 \lispnarrowing = #1em |
|
884 \fi |
|
885 \fi |
|
886 } |
|
887 |
|
888 % @firstparagraphindent WORD |
|
889 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph |
|
890 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such |
|
891 % paragraphs. |
|
892 % |
|
893 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling |
|
894 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do. |
|
895 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD. |
|
896 % By default, we suppress indentation. |
|
897 % |
|
898 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent} |
|
899 \newdimen\currentparindent |
|
900 % |
|
901 \def\insertword{insert} |
|
902 % |
|
903 \def\firstparagraphindent{\parsearg\dofirstparagraphindent} |
|
904 \def\dofirstparagraphindent#1{% |
|
905 \def\temp{#1}% |
|
906 \ifx\temp\noneword |
|
907 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent |
|
908 \else\ifx\temp\insertword |
|
909 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax |
|
910 \else |
|
911 \errhelp = \EMsimple |
|
912 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}% |
|
913 \fi\fi |
|
914 } |
|
915 |
|
916 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to |
|
917 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty. |
|
918 % |
|
919 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next |
|
920 % paragraph. |
|
921 % |
|
922 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{% |
|
923 \gdef\indent{% |
|
924 \global\let\indent=\ptexindent |
|
925 \global\everypar = {}% |
|
926 }% |
|
927 \global\everypar = {% |
|
928 \kern-\parindent |
|
929 \global\let\indent=\ptexindent |
|
930 \global\everypar = {}% |
|
931 }% |
|
932 }% |
|
933 |
|
934 |
|
935 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example. |
|
936 % |
|
937 \def\asis#1{#1} |
|
938 |
|
939 % @math outputs its argument in math mode. |
|
940 % We don't use $'s directly in the definition of \math because we need |
|
941 % to set catcodes according to plain TeX first, to allow for subscripts, |
|
942 % superscripts, special math chars, etc. |
|
943 % |
|
944 \let\implicitmath = $%$ font-lock fix |
|
945 % |
|
946 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean |
|
947 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make |
|
948 % _ within @math be active (mathcode "8000), and distinguish by seeing |
|
949 % if the current family is \slfam, which is what @var uses. |
|
950 % |
|
951 {\catcode\underChar = \active |
|
952 \gdef\mathunderscore{% |
|
953 \catcode\underChar=\active |
|
954 \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}% |
|
955 }} |
|
956 % |
|
957 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character. |
|
958 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but |
|
959 % this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not |
|
960 % otherwise define @\. |
|
961 % |
|
962 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\. |
|
963 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi} |
|
964 % |
|
965 \def\math{% |
|
966 \tex |
|
967 \mathcode`\_="8000 \mathunderscore |
|
968 \let\\ = \mathbackslash |
|
969 \mathactive |
|
970 \implicitmath\finishmath} |
|
971 \def\finishmath#1{#1\implicitmath\Etex} |
|
972 |
|
973 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math. |
|
974 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an |
|
975 % argument to a command which set the catcodes (such as @item or @section). |
|
976 % |
|
977 { |
|
978 \catcode`^ = \active |
|
979 \catcode`< = \active |
|
980 \catcode`> = \active |
|
981 \catcode`+ = \active |
|
982 \gdef\mathactive{% |
|
983 \let^ = \ptexhat |
|
984 \let< = \ptexless |
|
985 \let> = \ptexgtr |
|
986 \let+ = \ptexplus |
|
987 } |
|
988 } |
|
989 |
|
990 % @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above. |
|
991 \def\bullet{\implicitmath\ptexbullet\implicitmath} |
|
992 \def\minus{\implicitmath-\implicitmath} |
|
993 |
|
994 % @refill is a no-op. |
|
995 \let\refill=\relax |
|
996 |
|
997 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to |
|
998 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs. |
|
999 % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename). |
|
1000 % |
|
1001 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files. |
|
1002 \let\novalidate = \linksfalse |
|
1003 |
|
1004 % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file. |
|
1005 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input. |
|
1006 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo. |
|
1007 \def\setfilename{% |
|
1008 \iflinks |
|
1009 \readauxfile |
|
1010 \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case. |
|
1011 \openindices |
|
1012 \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'. |
|
1013 \global\let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds. |
|
1014 % |
|
1015 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it. |
|
1016 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. |
|
1017 % Just to be on the safe side, close the input stream before the \input. |
|
1018 \openin 1 texinfo.cnf |
|
1019 \ifeof1 \let\temp=\relax \else \def\temp{\input texinfo.cnf }\fi |
|
1020 \closein1 |
|
1021 \temp |
|
1022 % |
|
1023 \comment % Ignore the actual filename. |
|
1024 } |
|
1025 |
|
1026 % Called from \setfilename. |
|
1027 % |
|
1028 \def\openindices{% |
|
1029 \newindex{cp}% |
|
1030 \newcodeindex{fn}% |
|
1031 \newcodeindex{vr}% |
|
1032 \newcodeindex{tp}% |
|
1033 \newcodeindex{ky}% |
|
1034 \newcodeindex{pg}% |
|
1035 } |
|
1036 |
|
1037 % @bye. |
|
1038 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend} |
|
1039 |
|
1040 |
|
1041 \message{pdf,} |
|
1042 % adobe `portable' document format |
|
1043 \newcount\tempnum |
|
1044 \newcount\lnkcount |
|
1045 \newtoks\filename |
|
1046 \newcount\filenamelength |
|
1047 \newcount\pgn |
|
1048 \newtoks\toksA |
|
1049 \newtoks\toksB |
|
1050 \newtoks\toksC |
|
1051 \newtoks\toksD |
|
1052 \newbox\boxA |
|
1053 \newcount\countA |
|
1054 \newif\ifpdf |
|
1055 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest |
|
1056 |
|
1057 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined |
|
1058 \pdffalse |
|
1059 \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble |
|
1060 \let\pdfurl = \gobble |
|
1061 \let\endlink = \relax |
|
1062 \let\linkcolor = \relax |
|
1063 \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax |
|
1064 \else |
|
1065 \pdftrue |
|
1066 \pdfoutput = 1 |
|
1067 \input pdfcolor |
|
1068 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{% |
|
1069 \def\imagewidth{#2}% |
|
1070 \def\imageheight{#3}% |
|
1071 % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is |
|
1072 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.) |
|
1073 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 |
|
1074 \immediate\pdfimage |
|
1075 \else |
|
1076 \immediate\pdfximage |
|
1077 \fi |
|
1078 \ifx\empty\imagewidth\else width \imagewidth \fi |
|
1079 \ifx\empty\imageheight\else height \imageheight \fi |
|
1080 \ifnum\pdftexversion<13 |
|
1081 #1.pdf% |
|
1082 \else |
|
1083 {#1.pdf}% |
|
1084 \fi |
|
1085 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else |
|
1086 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage |
|
1087 \fi} |
|
1088 \def\pdfmkdest#1{{\normalturnoffactive \pdfdest name{#1} xyz}} |
|
1089 \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1} |
|
1090 \let\linkcolor = \Blue % was Cyan, but that seems light? |
|
1091 \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink} |
|
1092 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines |
|
1093 % come from Petr Olsak |
|
1094 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0% |
|
1095 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi} |
|
1096 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax |
|
1097 \advance\tempnum by1 |
|
1098 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}} |
|
1099 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{{% |
|
1100 \openin 1 \jobname.toc |
|
1101 \ifeof 1\else\begingroup |
|
1102 \closein 1 |
|
1103 % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks |
|
1104 \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace |
|
1105 \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace |
|
1106 % |
|
1107 \def\chapentry ##1##2##3{} |
|
1108 \def\secentry ##1##2##3##4{\advancenumber{chap##2}} |
|
1109 \def\subsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{\advancenumber{sec##2.##3}} |
|
1110 \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{\advancenumber{subsec##2.##3.##4}} |
|
1111 \let\appendixentry = \chapentry |
|
1112 \let\unnumbchapentry = \chapentry |
|
1113 \let\unnumbsecentry = \secentry |
|
1114 \let\unnumbsubsecentry = \subsecentry |
|
1115 \let\unnumbsubsubsecentry = \subsubsecentry |
|
1116 \input \jobname.toc |
|
1117 \def\chapentry ##1##2##3{% |
|
1118 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##3}}count-\expnumber{chap##2}{##1}} |
|
1119 \def\secentry ##1##2##3##4{% |
|
1120 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##4}}count-\expnumber{sec##2.##3}{##1}} |
|
1121 \def\subsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{% |
|
1122 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##5}}count-\expnumber{subsec##2.##3.##4}{##1}} |
|
1123 \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{% |
|
1124 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{##6}}{##1}} |
|
1125 \let\appendixentry = \chapentry |
|
1126 \let\unnumbchapentry = \chapentry |
|
1127 \let\unnumbsecentry = \secentry |
|
1128 \let\unnumbsubsecentry = \subsecentry |
|
1129 \let\unnumbsubsubsecentry = \subsubsecentry |
|
1130 % |
|
1131 % Make special characters normal for writing to the pdf file. |
|
1132 % |
|
1133 \indexnofonts |
|
1134 \let\tt=\relax |
|
1135 \turnoffactive |
|
1136 \input \jobname.toc |
|
1137 \endgroup\fi |
|
1138 }} |
|
1139 \def\makelinks #1,{% |
|
1140 \def\params{#1}\def\E{END}% |
|
1141 \ifx\params\E |
|
1142 \let\nextmakelinks=\relax |
|
1143 \else |
|
1144 \let\nextmakelinks=\makelinks |
|
1145 \ifnum\lnkcount>0,\fi |
|
1146 \picknum{#1}% |
|
1147 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} |
|
1148 goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\the\pgn}}% |
|
1149 \linkcolor #1% |
|
1150 \advance\lnkcount by 1% |
|
1151 \endlink |
|
1152 \fi |
|
1153 \nextmakelinks |
|
1154 } |
|
1155 \def\picknum#1{\expandafter\pn#1} |
|
1156 \def\pn#1{% |
|
1157 \def\p{#1}% |
|
1158 \ifx\p\lbrace |
|
1159 \let\nextpn=\ppn |
|
1160 \else |
|
1161 \let\nextpn=\ppnn |
|
1162 \def\first{#1} |
|
1163 \fi |
|
1164 \nextpn |
|
1165 } |
|
1166 \def\ppn#1{\pgn=#1\gobble} |
|
1167 \def\ppnn{\pgn=\first} |
|
1168 \def\pdfmklnk#1{\lnkcount=0\makelinks #1,END,} |
|
1169 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} |
|
1170 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}% |
|
1171 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax |
|
1172 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces |
|
1173 \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}% |
|
1174 \advance\filenamelength by 1 |
|
1175 \fi |
|
1176 \fi |
|
1177 \nextsp} |
|
1178 \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax} |
|
1179 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 |
|
1180 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink |
|
1181 \else |
|
1182 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink |
|
1183 \fi |
|
1184 \def\pdfurl#1{% |
|
1185 \begingroup |
|
1186 \normalturnoffactive\def\@{@}% |
|
1187 \let\value=\expandablevalue |
|
1188 \leavevmode\Red |
|
1189 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% |
|
1190 user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}% |
|
1191 % #1 |
|
1192 \endgroup} |
|
1193 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}} |
|
1194 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} |
|
1195 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks} |
|
1196 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}} |
|
1197 \def\maketoks{% |
|
1198 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS| |
|
1199 \ifx\first0\adn0 |
|
1200 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3 |
|
1201 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6 |
|
1202 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9 |
|
1203 \else |
|
1204 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi |
|
1205 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else |
|
1206 \let\next=\maketoks |
|
1207 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD} |
|
1208 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi |
|
1209 \fi |
|
1210 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi |
|
1211 \next} |
|
1212 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}% |
|
1213 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0} |
|
1214 \def\pdflink#1{% |
|
1215 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}} |
|
1216 \linkcolor #1\endlink} |
|
1217 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st} |
|
1218 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput |
|
1219 |
|
1220 |
|
1221 \message{fonts,} |
|
1222 % Font-change commands. |
|
1223 |
|
1224 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not. |
|
1225 % So we set up a \sf analogous to plain's \rm, etc. |
|
1226 \newfam\sffam |
|
1227 \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \tensf} |
|
1228 \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf. |
|
1229 |
|
1230 % We don't need math for this one. |
|
1231 \def\ttsl{\tenttsl} |
|
1232 |
|
1233 % Default leading. |
|
1234 \newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt |
|
1235 |
|
1236 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size |
|
1237 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers |
|
1238 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined. |
|
1239 % |
|
1240 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333} |
|
1241 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833} |
|
1242 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167} |
|
1243 % |
|
1244 \def\setleading#1{% |
|
1245 \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax |
|
1246 \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip |
|
1247 \normalbaselines |
|
1248 \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{% |
|
1249 \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip |
|
1250 depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip |
|
1251 }% |
|
1252 } |
|
1253 |
|
1254 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the |
|
1255 % specified font prefix (normally `cm'). |
|
1256 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor |
|
1257 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4{\font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4} |
|
1258 |
|
1259 % Use cm as the default font prefix. |
|
1260 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix |
|
1261 % before you read in texinfo.tex. |
|
1262 \ifx\fontprefix\undefined |
|
1263 \def\fontprefix{cm} |
|
1264 \fi |
|
1265 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM. |
|
1266 \def\rmshape{r} |
|
1267 \def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold |
|
1268 \def\bfshape{b} |
|
1269 \def\bxshape{bx} |
|
1270 \def\ttshape{tt} |
|
1271 \def\ttbshape{tt} |
|
1272 \def\ttslshape{sltt} |
|
1273 \def\itshape{ti} |
|
1274 \def\itbshape{bxti} |
|
1275 \def\slshape{sl} |
|
1276 \def\slbshape{bxsl} |
|
1277 \def\sfshape{ss} |
|
1278 \def\sfbshape{ss} |
|
1279 \def\scshape{csc} |
|
1280 \def\scbshape{csc} |
|
1281 |
|
1282 \newcount\mainmagstep |
|
1283 \ifx\bigger\relax |
|
1284 % not really supported. |
|
1285 \mainmagstep=\magstep1 |
|
1286 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{12}{1000} |
|
1287 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{12}{1000} |
|
1288 \else |
|
1289 \mainmagstep=\magstephalf |
|
1290 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
|
1291 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
|
1292 \fi |
|
1293 % Instead of cmb10, you may want to use cmbx10. |
|
1294 % cmbx10 is a prettier font on its own, but cmb10 |
|
1295 % looks better when embedded in a line with cmr10 |
|
1296 % (in Bob's opinion). |
|
1297 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
|
1298 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
|
1299 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
|
1300 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
|
1301 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
|
1302 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep} |
|
1303 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep |
|
1304 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep |
|
1305 |
|
1306 % A few fonts for @defun, etc. |
|
1307 \setfont\defbf\bxshape{10}{\magstep1} %was 1314 |
|
1308 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1} |
|
1309 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \bf} |
|
1310 |
|
1311 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt). |
|
1312 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000} |
|
1313 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000} |
|
1314 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900} |
|
1315 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000} |
|
1316 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000} |
|
1317 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000} |
|
1318 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900} |
|
1319 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900} |
|
1320 \font\smalli=cmmi9 |
|
1321 \font\smallsy=cmsy9 |
|
1322 |
|
1323 % Fonts for small examples (8pt). |
|
1324 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000} |
|
1325 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000} |
|
1326 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800} |
|
1327 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000} |
|
1328 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000} |
|
1329 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000} |
|
1330 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800} |
|
1331 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800} |
|
1332 \font\smalleri=cmmi8 |
|
1333 \font\smallersy=cmsy8 |
|
1334 |
|
1335 % Fonts for title page: |
|
1336 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3} |
|
1337 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4} |
|
1338 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4} |
|
1339 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3} |
|
1340 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4} |
|
1341 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1} |
|
1342 \let\titlebf=\titlerm |
|
1343 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4} |
|
1344 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3 |
|
1345 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4 |
|
1346 \def\authorrm{\secrm} |
|
1347 \def\authortt{\sectt} |
|
1348 |
|
1349 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt). |
|
1350 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2} |
|
1351 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3} |
|
1352 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3} |
|
1353 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2} |
|
1354 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3} |
|
1355 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000} |
|
1356 \let\chapbf=\chaprm |
|
1357 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3} |
|
1358 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2 |
|
1359 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3 |
|
1360 |
|
1361 % Section fonts (14.4pt). |
|
1362 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1} |
|
1363 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2} |
|
1364 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2} |
|
1365 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1} |
|
1366 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2} |
|
1367 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1} |
|
1368 \let\secbf\secrm |
|
1369 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2} |
|
1370 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1 |
|
1371 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2 |
|
1372 |
|
1373 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt). |
|
1374 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf} |
|
1375 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315} |
|
1376 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315} |
|
1377 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf} |
|
1378 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315} |
|
1379 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf} |
|
1380 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm |
|
1381 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1} |
|
1382 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf |
|
1383 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315 |
|
1384 % The smallcaps and symbol fonts should actually be scaled \magstep1.5, |
|
1385 % but that is not a standard magnification. |
|
1386 |
|
1387 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters, |
|
1388 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since |
|
1389 % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except |
|
1390 % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and |
|
1391 % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts). |
|
1392 % |
|
1393 \def\resetmathfonts{% |
|
1394 \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy |
|
1395 \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf |
|
1396 \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf |
|
1397 } |
|
1398 |
|
1399 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead |
|
1400 % of just \STYLE. We do this so that font changes will continue to work |
|
1401 % in math mode, where it is the current \fam that is relevant in most |
|
1402 % cases, not the current font. Plain TeX does \def\bf{\fam=\bffam |
|
1403 % \tenbf}, for example. By redefining \tenbf, we obviate the need to |
|
1404 % redefine \bf itself. |
|
1405 \def\textfonts{% |
|
1406 \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl |
|
1407 \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc |
|
1408 \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy \let\tenttsl=\textttsl |
|
1409 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}} |
|
1410 \def\titlefonts{% |
|
1411 \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl |
|
1412 \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc |
|
1413 \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy |
|
1414 \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl |
|
1415 \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}} |
|
1416 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}} |
|
1417 \def\chapfonts{% |
|
1418 \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl |
|
1419 \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc |
|
1420 \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl |
|
1421 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}} |
|
1422 \def\secfonts{% |
|
1423 \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl |
|
1424 \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc |
|
1425 \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy \let\tenttsl=\secttsl |
|
1426 \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}} |
|
1427 \def\subsecfonts{% |
|
1428 \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl |
|
1429 \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc |
|
1430 \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl |
|
1431 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}} |
|
1432 \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts % Maybe make sssec fonts scaled magstephalf? |
|
1433 \def\smallfonts{% |
|
1434 \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl |
|
1435 \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc |
|
1436 \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy |
|
1437 \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl |
|
1438 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} |
|
1439 \def\smallerfonts{% |
|
1440 \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl |
|
1441 \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc |
|
1442 \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy |
|
1443 \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl |
|
1444 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}} |
|
1445 |
|
1446 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments. |
|
1447 \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts |
|
1448 |
|
1449 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample |
|
1450 % can fit this many characters: |
|
1451 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69 |
|
1452 % If we use \smallerfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters: |
|
1453 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77 |
|
1454 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth |
|
1455 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt. |
|
1456 % |
|
1457 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt): |
|
1458 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58 |
|
1459 % |
|
1460 % I wish we used A4 paper on this side of the Atlantic. |
|
1461 % |
|
1462 % --karl, 24jan03. |
|
1463 |
|
1464 |
|
1465 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes. |
|
1466 % |
|
1467 \textfonts |
|
1468 |
|
1469 % Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts. |
|
1470 \def\angleleft{$\langle$} |
|
1471 \def\angleright{$\rangle$} |
|
1472 |
|
1473 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks |
|
1474 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0 |
|
1475 |
|
1476 % Fonts for short table of contents. |
|
1477 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000} |
|
1478 \setfont\shortcontbf\bxshape{12}{1000} |
|
1479 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000} |
|
1480 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000} |
|
1481 |
|
1482 %% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans |
|
1483 %% serif) and @ii for TeX italic |
|
1484 |
|
1485 % \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction |
|
1486 % unless the following character is such as not to need one. |
|
1487 \def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else |
|
1488 \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi} |
|
1489 \def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} |
|
1490 \def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} |
|
1491 |
|
1492 \let\i=\smartitalic |
|
1493 \let\var=\smartslanted |
|
1494 \let\dfn=\smartslanted |
|
1495 \let\emph=\smartitalic |
|
1496 \let\cite=\smartslanted |
|
1497 |
|
1498 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}} |
|
1499 \let\strong=\b |
|
1500 |
|
1501 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at |
|
1502 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the |
|
1503 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called. |
|
1504 % |
|
1505 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation} |
|
1506 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- } |
|
1507 |
|
1508 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value. |
|
1509 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and |
|
1510 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up. |
|
1511 % |
|
1512 \catcode`@=11 |
|
1513 \def\frenchspacing{% |
|
1514 \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m |
|
1515 \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m |
|
1516 } |
|
1517 \catcode`@=\other |
|
1518 |
|
1519 \def\t#1{% |
|
1520 {\tt \rawbackslash \frenchspacing #1}% |
|
1521 \null |
|
1522 } |
|
1523 \let\ttfont=\t |
|
1524 \def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null} |
|
1525 \setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000} |
|
1526 \font\keysy=cmsy9 |
|
1527 \def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{% |
|
1528 \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{% |
|
1529 \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt |
|
1530 \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}% |
|
1531 \kern-0.4pt\hrule}% |
|
1532 \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}} |
|
1533 % The old definition, with no lozenge: |
|
1534 %\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null} |
|
1535 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1} |
|
1536 |
|
1537 % @file, @option are the same as @samp. |
|
1538 \let\file=\samp |
|
1539 \let\option=\samp |
|
1540 |
|
1541 % @code is a modification of @t, |
|
1542 % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text. |
|
1543 \def\tclose#1{% |
|
1544 {% |
|
1545 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font. |
|
1546 \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font |
|
1547 % |
|
1548 % Switch to typewriter. |
|
1549 \tt |
|
1550 % |
|
1551 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space. |
|
1552 \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}% |
|
1553 % |
|
1554 % Turn off hyphenation. |
|
1555 \nohyphenation |
|
1556 % |
|
1557 \rawbackslash |
|
1558 \frenchspacing |
|
1559 #1% |
|
1560 }% |
|
1561 \null |
|
1562 } |
|
1563 |
|
1564 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in \code. |
|
1565 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes |
|
1566 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc. |
|
1567 |
|
1568 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control |
|
1569 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words. |
|
1570 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that) |
|
1571 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. |
|
1572 % -- rms. |
|
1573 { |
|
1574 \catcode`\-=\active |
|
1575 \catcode`\_=\active |
|
1576 % |
|
1577 \global\def\code{\begingroup |
|
1578 \catcode`\-=\active \let-\codedash |
|
1579 \catcode`\_=\active \let_\codeunder |
|
1580 \codex |
|
1581 } |
|
1582 % |
|
1583 % If we end up with any active - characters when handling the index, |
|
1584 % just treat them as a normal -. |
|
1585 \global\def\indexbreaks{\catcode`\-=\active \let-\realdash} |
|
1586 } |
|
1587 |
|
1588 \def\realdash{-} |
|
1589 \def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}} |
|
1590 \def\codeunder{% |
|
1591 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _ |
|
1592 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.) |
|
1593 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us |
|
1594 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop. |
|
1595 \ifusingtt{\ifmmode |
|
1596 \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_. |
|
1597 \else\normalunderscore \fi |
|
1598 \discretionary{}{}{}}% |
|
1599 {\_}% |
|
1600 } |
|
1601 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup} |
|
1602 |
|
1603 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command, |
|
1604 % then @kbd has no effect. |
|
1605 |
|
1606 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always), |
|
1607 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends), |
|
1608 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always). |
|
1609 \def\kbdinputstyle{\parsearg\kbdinputstylexxx} |
|
1610 \def\kbdinputstylexxx#1{% |
|
1611 \def\arg{#1}% |
|
1612 \ifx\arg\worddistinct |
|
1613 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}% |
|
1614 \else\ifx\arg\wordexample |
|
1615 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% |
|
1616 \else\ifx\arg\wordcode |
|
1617 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% |
|
1618 \else |
|
1619 \errhelp = \EMsimple |
|
1620 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\arg'}% |
|
1621 \fi\fi\fi |
|
1622 } |
|
1623 \def\worddistinct{distinct} |
|
1624 \def\wordexample{example} |
|
1625 \def\wordcode{code} |
|
1626 |
|
1627 % Default is `distinct.' |
|
1628 \kbdinputstyle distinct |
|
1629 |
|
1630 \def\xkey{\key} |
|
1631 \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}% |
|
1632 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}% |
|
1633 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi |
|
1634 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi} |
|
1635 |
|
1636 % For @url, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code. |
|
1637 \let\url=\code |
|
1638 \let\env=\code |
|
1639 \let\command=\code |
|
1640 |
|
1641 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated) |
|
1642 % second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third |
|
1643 % arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url |
|
1644 % itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in |
|
1645 % a hypertex \special here. |
|
1646 % |
|
1647 \def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish} |
|
1648 \def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup |
|
1649 \unsepspaces |
|
1650 \pdfurl{#1}% |
|
1651 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% |
|
1652 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt |
|
1653 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that |
|
1654 \else |
|
1655 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% |
|
1656 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt |
|
1657 \ifpdf |
|
1658 \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it |
|
1659 \else |
|
1660 \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url |
|
1661 \fi |
|
1662 \else |
|
1663 \code{#1}% only url given, so show it |
|
1664 \fi |
|
1665 \fi |
|
1666 \endlink |
|
1667 \endgroup} |
|
1668 |
|
1669 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97. |
|
1670 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf. |
|
1671 % |
|
1672 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright} |
|
1673 \ifpdf |
|
1674 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish} |
|
1675 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup |
|
1676 \unsepspaces |
|
1677 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}% |
|
1678 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% |
|
1679 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi |
|
1680 \endlink |
|
1681 \endgroup} |
|
1682 \else |
|
1683 \let\email=\uref |
|
1684 \fi |
|
1685 |
|
1686 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the |
|
1687 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and |
|
1688 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have |
|
1689 % this property, we can check that font parameter. |
|
1690 % |
|
1691 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt } |
|
1692 |
|
1693 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the |
|
1694 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt. |
|
1695 % |
|
1696 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1} |
|
1697 |
|
1698 \def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par} |
|
1699 |
|
1700 % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'', |
|
1701 % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for |
|
1702 % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96. |
|
1703 %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null} |
|
1704 |
|
1705 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii. |
|
1706 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font |
|
1707 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font |
|
1708 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font |
|
1709 |
|
1710 % @acronym downcases the argument and prints in smallcaps. |
|
1711 \def\acronym#1{{\smallcaps \lowercase{#1}}} |
|
1712 |
|
1713 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign. |
|
1714 \def\pounds{{\it\$}} |
|
1715 |
|
1716 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. For now, only works in text size; |
|
1717 % we'd have to redo the font mechanism to change the \scriptstyle and |
|
1718 % \scriptscriptstyle font sizes to make it look right in headings. |
|
1719 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright. |
|
1720 % |
|
1721 \def\registeredsymbol{% |
|
1722 $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{$\scriptstyle\rm R$}\hfil\crcr\Orb}}% |
|
1723 }$% |
|
1724 } |
|
1725 |
|
1726 |
|
1727 \message{page headings,} |
|
1728 |
|
1729 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in |
|
1730 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc |
|
1731 |
|
1732 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage. |
|
1733 \newif\ifseenauthor |
|
1734 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage |
|
1735 |
|
1736 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the |
|
1737 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage. |
|
1738 % |
|
1739 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage |
|
1740 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue |
|
1741 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage |
|
1742 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue |
|
1743 |
|
1744 \def\shorttitlepage{\parsearg\shorttitlepagezzz} |
|
1745 \def\shorttitlepagezzz #1{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}% |
|
1746 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page} |
|
1747 |
|
1748 \def\titlepage{\begingroup \parindent=0pt \textfonts |
|
1749 \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm |
|
1750 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}% |
|
1751 % |
|
1752 \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines |
|
1753 \let\tt=\authortt}% |
|
1754 % |
|
1755 % Leave some space at the very top of the page. |
|
1756 \vglue\titlepagetopglue |
|
1757 % |
|
1758 % Now you can print the title using @title. |
|
1759 \def\title{\parsearg\titlezzz}% |
|
1760 \def\titlezzz##1{\leftline{\titlefonts\rm ##1} |
|
1761 % print a rule at the page bottom also. |
|
1762 \finishedtitlepagefalse |
|
1763 \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt}% |
|
1764 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title. |
|
1765 \finishedtitlepagetrue |
|
1766 % |
|
1767 % Now you can put text using @subtitle. |
|
1768 \def\subtitle{\parsearg\subtitlezzz}% |
|
1769 \def\subtitlezzz##1{{\subtitlefont \rightline{##1}}}% |
|
1770 % |
|
1771 % @author should come last, but may come many times. |
|
1772 \def\author{\parsearg\authorzzz}% |
|
1773 \def\authorzzz##1{\ifseenauthor\else\vskip 0pt plus 1filll\seenauthortrue\fi |
|
1774 {\authorfont \leftline{##1}}}% |
|
1775 % |
|
1776 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space |
|
1777 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second. |
|
1778 \let\oldpage = \page |
|
1779 \def\page{% |
|
1780 \iffinishedtitlepage\else |
|
1781 \finishtitlepage |
|
1782 \fi |
|
1783 \oldpage |
|
1784 \let\page = \oldpage |
|
1785 \hbox{}}% |
|
1786 % \def\page{\oldpage \hbox{}} |
|
1787 } |
|
1788 |
|
1789 \def\Etitlepage{% |
|
1790 \iffinishedtitlepage\else |
|
1791 \finishtitlepage |
|
1792 \fi |
|
1793 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group, |
|
1794 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group. |
|
1795 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page |
|
1796 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want. |
|
1797 \oldpage |
|
1798 \endgroup |
|
1799 % |
|
1800 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are |
|
1801 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers. |
|
1802 \HEADINGSon |
|
1803 % |
|
1804 % If they want short, they certainly want long too. |
|
1805 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage |
|
1806 \shortcontents |
|
1807 \contents |
|
1808 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax |
|
1809 \global\let\contents = \relax |
|
1810 \fi |
|
1811 % |
|
1812 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage |
|
1813 \contents |
|
1814 \global\let\contents = \relax |
|
1815 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax |
|
1816 \fi |
|
1817 } |
|
1818 |
|
1819 \def\finishtitlepage{% |
|
1820 \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize |
|
1821 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue |
|
1822 \finishedtitlepagetrue |
|
1823 } |
|
1824 |
|
1825 %%% Set up page headings and footings. |
|
1826 |
|
1827 \let\thispage=\folio |
|
1828 |
|
1829 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages |
|
1830 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages |
|
1831 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages |
|
1832 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages |
|
1833 |
|
1834 % Now make Tex use those variables |
|
1835 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline |
|
1836 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}} |
|
1837 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline |
|
1838 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook} |
|
1839 \let\HEADINGShook=\relax |
|
1840 |
|
1841 % Commands to set those variables. |
|
1842 % For example, this is what @headings on does |
|
1843 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter |
|
1844 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle |
|
1845 % @evenfooting @thisfile|| |
|
1846 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile |
|
1847 |
|
1848 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx} |
|
1849 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx} |
|
1850 \def\everyheading{\parsearg\everyheadingxxx} |
|
1851 |
|
1852 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx} |
|
1853 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx} |
|
1854 \def\everyfooting{\parsearg\everyfootingxxx} |
|
1855 |
|
1856 {\catcode`\@=0 % |
|
1857 |
|
1858 \gdef\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish} |
|
1859 \gdef\evenheadingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{% |
|
1860 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} |
|
1861 |
|
1862 \gdef\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish} |
|
1863 \gdef\oddheadingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{% |
|
1864 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} |
|
1865 |
|
1866 \gdef\everyheadingxxx#1{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}% |
|
1867 |
|
1868 \gdef\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish} |
|
1869 \gdef\evenfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{% |
|
1870 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} |
|
1871 |
|
1872 \gdef\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish} |
|
1873 \gdef\oddfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{% |
|
1874 \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}% |
|
1875 % |
|
1876 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume |
|
1877 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself. |
|
1878 \global\advance\pageheight by -\baselineskip |
|
1879 \global\advance\vsize by -\baselineskip |
|
1880 } |
|
1881 |
|
1882 \gdef\everyfootingxxx#1{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}} |
|
1883 % |
|
1884 }% unbind the catcode of @. |
|
1885 |
|
1886 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing. |
|
1887 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing. |
|
1888 % @headings off turns them off. |
|
1889 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility. |
|
1890 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page. |
|
1891 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page. |
|
1892 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page. |
|
1893 % By default, they are off at the start of a document, |
|
1894 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage. |
|
1895 |
|
1896 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname} |
|
1897 |
|
1898 \def\HEADINGSoff{ |
|
1899 \global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
|
1900 \global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}} |
|
1901 \HEADINGSoff |
|
1902 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1. |
|
1903 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner, |
|
1904 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document |
|
1905 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top |
|
1906 % edge of all pages. |
|
1907 \def\HEADINGSdouble{ |
|
1908 \global\pageno=1 |
|
1909 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
|
1910 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} |
|
1911 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} |
|
1912 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
|
1913 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage |
|
1914 } |
|
1915 \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
|
1916 |
|
1917 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page, |
|
1918 % page number on top right. |
|
1919 \def\HEADINGSsingle{ |
|
1920 \global\pageno=1 |
|
1921 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
|
1922 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} |
|
1923 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
|
1924 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
|
1925 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
|
1926 } |
|
1927 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble} |
|
1928 |
|
1929 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex} |
|
1930 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter |
|
1931 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{% |
|
1932 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
|
1933 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} |
|
1934 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} |
|
1935 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
|
1936 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage |
|
1937 } |
|
1938 |
|
1939 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex} |
|
1940 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{% |
|
1941 \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
|
1942 \global\oddfootline={\hfil} |
|
1943 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
|
1944 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
|
1945 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
|
1946 } |
|
1947 |
|
1948 % Subroutines used in generating headings |
|
1949 % This produces Day Month Year style of output. |
|
1950 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set |
|
1951 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this). |
|
1952 \ifx\today\undefined |
|
1953 \def\today{% |
|
1954 \number\day\space |
|
1955 \ifcase\month |
|
1956 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr |
|
1957 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug |
|
1958 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec |
|
1959 \fi |
|
1960 \space\number\year} |
|
1961 \fi |
|
1962 |
|
1963 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings. |
|
1964 % It generates no output of its own. |
|
1965 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle} |
|
1966 \def\settitle{\parsearg\settitlezzz} |
|
1967 \def\settitlezzz #1{\gdef\thistitle{#1}} |
|
1968 |
|
1969 |
|
1970 \message{tables,} |
|
1971 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x), @kitem(x), @xitem(x). |
|
1972 |
|
1973 % default indentation of table text |
|
1974 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in |
|
1975 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text |
|
1976 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in |
|
1977 % margin between end of table item and start of table text. |
|
1978 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in |
|
1979 |
|
1980 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin |
|
1981 \newdimen\itemmax |
|
1982 |
|
1983 % Note @table, @vtable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with |
|
1984 % these defs. |
|
1985 % They also define \itemindex |
|
1986 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none). |
|
1987 |
|
1988 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip |
|
1989 |
|
1990 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi} |
|
1991 |
|
1992 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz} |
|
1993 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz} |
|
1994 |
|
1995 \def\internalBxitem "#1"{\def\xitemsubtopix{#1} \smallbreak \parsearg\xitemzzz} |
|
1996 \def\internalBxitemx "#1"{\def\xitemsubtopix{#1} \itemxpar \parsearg\xitemzzz} |
|
1997 |
|
1998 \def\internalBkitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\kitemzzz} |
|
1999 \def\internalBkitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\kitemzzz} |
|
2000 |
|
2001 \def\kitemzzz #1{\dosubind {kw}{\code{#1}}{for {\bf \lastfunction}}% |
|
2002 \itemzzz {#1}} |
|
2003 |
|
2004 \def\xitemzzz #1{\dosubind {kw}{\code{#1}}{for {\bf \xitemsubtopic}}% |
|
2005 \itemzzz {#1}} |
|
2006 |
|
2007 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup % |
|
2008 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip |
|
2009 \advance\hsize by -\tableindent |
|
2010 \setbox0=\hbox{\itemfont{#1}}% |
|
2011 \itemindex{#1}% |
|
2012 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx. |
|
2013 % |
|
2014 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line |
|
2015 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that |
|
2016 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next |
|
2017 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the |
|
2018 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space. |
|
2019 \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax |
|
2020 % |
|
2021 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping, |
|
2022 % but leave it ragged-right. |
|
2023 \begingroup |
|
2024 \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent |
|
2025 \advance\hsize by\tableindent |
|
2026 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil |
|
2027 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par |
|
2028 \endgroup |
|
2029 % |
|
2030 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the |
|
2031 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started. |
|
2032 \nobreak \vskip-\parskip |
|
2033 % |
|
2034 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. (Unfortunately |
|
2035 % we can't prevent a possible page break at the following |
|
2036 % \baselineskip glue.) However, if what follows is an environment |
|
2037 % such as @example, there will be no \parskip glue; then |
|
2038 % the negative vskip we just would cause the example and the item to |
|
2039 % crash together. So we use this bizarre value of 10001 as a signal |
|
2040 % to \aboveenvbreak to insert \parskip glue after all. |
|
2041 % (Possibly there are other commands that could be followed by |
|
2042 % @example which need the same treatment, but not section titles; or |
|
2043 % maybe section titles are the only special case and they should be |
|
2044 % penalty 10001...) |
|
2045 \penalty 10001 |
|
2046 \endgroup |
|
2047 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse |
|
2048 \else |
|
2049 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the |
|
2050 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line. |
|
2051 \noindent |
|
2052 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in |
|
2053 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and |
|
2054 % eventually be printed. |
|
2055 \nobreak\kern-\tableindent |
|
2056 \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 |
|
2057 \unhbox0 |
|
2058 \nobreak\kern\dimen0 |
|
2059 \endgroup |
|
2060 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue |
|
2061 \fi |
|
2062 } |
|
2063 |
|
2064 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a table}} |
|
2065 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a table}} |
|
2066 \def\kitem{\errmessage{@kitem while not in a table}} |
|
2067 \def\kitemx{\errmessage{@kitemx while not in a table}} |
|
2068 \def\xitem{\errmessage{@xitem while not in a table}} |
|
2069 \def\xitemx{\errmessage{@xitemx while not in a table}} |
|
2070 |
|
2071 % Contains a kludge to get @end[description] to work. |
|
2072 \def\description{\tablez{\dontindex}{1}{}{}{}{}} |
|
2073 |
|
2074 % @table, @ftable, @vtable. |
|
2075 \def\table{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\tablex} |
|
2076 {\obeylines\obeyspaces% |
|
2077 \gdef\tablex #1^^M{% |
|
2078 \tabley\dontindex#1 \endtabley}} |
|
2079 |
|
2080 \def\ftable{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\ftablex} |
|
2081 {\obeylines\obeyspaces% |
|
2082 \gdef\ftablex #1^^M{% |
|
2083 \tabley\fnitemindex#1 \endtabley |
|
2084 \def\Eftable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}% |
|
2085 \let\Etable=\relax}} |
|
2086 |
|
2087 \def\vtable{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\vtablex} |
|
2088 {\obeylines\obeyspaces% |
|
2089 \gdef\vtablex #1^^M{% |
|
2090 \tabley\vritemindex#1 \endtabley |
|
2091 \def\Evtable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}% |
|
2092 \let\Etable=\relax}} |
|
2093 |
|
2094 \def\dontindex #1{} |
|
2095 \def\fnitemindex #1{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}}% |
|
2096 \def\vritemindex #1{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}}% |
|
2097 |
|
2098 {\obeyspaces % |
|
2099 \gdef\tabley#1#2 #3 #4 #5 #6 #7\endtabley{\endgroup% |
|
2100 \tablez{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}}} |
|
2101 |
|
2102 \def\tablez #1#2#3#4#5#6{% |
|
2103 \aboveenvbreak % |
|
2104 \begingroup % |
|
2105 \def\Edescription{\Etable}% Necessary kludge. |
|
2106 \let\itemindex=#1% |
|
2107 \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \leftskip by #3\mil \fi % |
|
2108 \ifnum 0#4>0 \tableindent=#4\mil \fi % |
|
2109 \ifnum 0#5>0 \advance \rightskip by #5\mil \fi % |
|
2110 \def\itemfont{#2}% |
|
2111 \itemmax=\tableindent % |
|
2112 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin % |
|
2113 \advance \leftskip by \tableindent % |
|
2114 \exdentamount=\tableindent |
|
2115 \parindent = 0pt |
|
2116 \parskip = \smallskipamount |
|
2117 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi% |
|
2118 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}% |
|
2119 \let\item = \internalBitem % |
|
2120 \let\itemx = \internalBitemx % |
|
2121 \let\kitem = \internalBkitem % |
|
2122 \let\kitemx = \internalBkitemx % |
|
2123 \let\xitem = \internalBxitem % |
|
2124 \let\xitemx = \internalBxitemx % |
|
2125 } |
|
2126 |
|
2127 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize |
|
2128 |
|
2129 \newcount \itemno |
|
2130 |
|
2131 \def\itemize{\parsearg\itemizezzz} |
|
2132 |
|
2133 \def\itemizezzz #1{% |
|
2134 \begingroup % ended by the @end itemize |
|
2135 \itemizey {#1}{\Eitemize} |
|
2136 } |
|
2137 |
|
2138 \def\itemizey#1#2{% |
|
2139 \aboveenvbreak |
|
2140 \itemmax=\itemindent |
|
2141 \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin |
|
2142 \advance\leftskip by \itemindent |
|
2143 \exdentamount=\itemindent |
|
2144 \parindent=0pt |
|
2145 \parskip=\smallskipamount |
|
2146 \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi |
|
2147 \def#2{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}% |
|
2148 \def\itemcontents{#1}% |
|
2149 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet. |
|
2150 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi |
|
2151 \let\item=\itemizeitem |
|
2152 } |
|
2153 |
|
2154 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in |
|
2155 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder. |
|
2156 % |
|
2157 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}% |
|
2158 |
|
2159 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter, |
|
2160 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No |
|
2161 % argument is the same as `1'. |
|
2162 % |
|
2163 \def\enumerate{\parsearg\enumeratezzz} |
|
2164 \def\enumeratezzz #1{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey} |
|
2165 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{% |
|
2166 \begingroup % ended by the @end enumerate |
|
2167 % |
|
2168 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'. |
|
2169 \def\thearg{#1}% |
|
2170 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi |
|
2171 % |
|
2172 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a |
|
2173 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number. |
|
2174 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made. |
|
2175 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at |
|
2176 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.) |
|
2177 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark |
|
2178 \ifx\rest\empty |
|
2179 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything. |
|
2180 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero. |
|
2181 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and |
|
2182 % not equal to itself. |
|
2183 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number. |
|
2184 % |
|
2185 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from |
|
2186 % continuing to look for a <number>. |
|
2187 % |
|
2188 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax |
|
2189 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope) |
|
2190 \else |
|
2191 % It's a letter. |
|
2192 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax |
|
2193 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter |
|
2194 \else |
|
2195 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter |
|
2196 \fi |
|
2197 \fi |
|
2198 \else |
|
2199 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number. |
|
2200 \numericenumerate |
|
2201 \fi |
|
2202 } |
|
2203 |
|
2204 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is |
|
2205 % given in \thearg. |
|
2206 % |
|
2207 \def\numericenumerate{% |
|
2208 \itemno = \thearg |
|
2209 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}% |
|
2210 } |
|
2211 |
|
2212 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg. |
|
2213 \def\lowercaseenumerate{% |
|
2214 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg |
|
2215 \startenumeration{% |
|
2216 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. |
|
2217 \ifnum\itemno=0 |
|
2218 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger |
|
2219 alphabet}% |
|
2220 \fi |
|
2221 \char\lccode\itemno |
|
2222 }% |
|
2223 } |
|
2224 |
|
2225 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg. |
|
2226 \def\uppercaseenumerate{% |
|
2227 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg |
|
2228 \startenumeration{% |
|
2229 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. |
|
2230 \ifnum\itemno=0 |
|
2231 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger |
|
2232 alphabet} |
|
2233 \fi |
|
2234 \char\uccode\itemno |
|
2235 }% |
|
2236 } |
|
2237 |
|
2238 % Call itemizey, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the |
|
2239 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in |
|
2240 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno. |
|
2241 % |
|
2242 \def\startenumeration#1{% |
|
2243 \advance\itemno by -1 |
|
2244 \itemizey{#1.}\Eenumerate\flushcr |
|
2245 } |
|
2246 |
|
2247 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg |
|
2248 % to @enumerate. |
|
2249 % |
|
2250 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}} |
|
2251 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}} |
|
2252 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate} |
|
2253 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate} |
|
2254 |
|
2255 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize. |
|
2256 |
|
2257 \def\itemizeitem{% |
|
2258 \advance\itemno by 1 |
|
2259 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% |
|
2260 \ifhmode \errmessage{In hmode at itemizeitem}\fi |
|
2261 {\parskip=0in \hskip 0pt |
|
2262 \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents\hskip \itemmargin}% |
|
2263 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% |
|
2264 \flushcr} |
|
2265 |
|
2266 % @multitable macros |
|
2267 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96 |
|
2268 % |
|
2269 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired. |
|
2270 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width |
|
2271 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line, |
|
2272 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page. |
|
2273 |
|
2274 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines. |
|
2275 |
|
2276 % To make preamble: |
|
2277 % |
|
2278 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize: |
|
2279 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45 |
|
2280 % @item ... |
|
2281 % |
|
2282 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total |
|
2283 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many |
|
2284 % columns as desired. |
|
2285 |
|
2286 |
|
2287 % Or use a template: |
|
2288 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} |
|
2289 % @item ... |
|
2290 % using the widest term desired in each column. |
|
2291 % |
|
2292 % For those who want to use more than one line's worth of words in |
|
2293 % the preamble, break the line within one argument and it |
|
2294 % will parse correctly, i.e., |
|
2295 % |
|
2296 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 |
|
2297 % template} |
|
2298 % Not: |
|
2299 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} |
|
2300 % {Column 3 template} |
|
2301 |
|
2302 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column |
|
2303 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's |
|
2304 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed, |
|
2305 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns. |
|
2306 |
|
2307 % @item, @tab, @multitable or @end multitable do not need to be on their |
|
2308 % own lines, but it will not hurt if they are. |
|
2309 |
|
2310 % Sample multitable: |
|
2311 |
|
2312 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} |
|
2313 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col |
|
2314 % @item |
|
2315 % first col stuff |
|
2316 % @tab |
|
2317 % second col stuff |
|
2318 % @tab |
|
2319 % third col |
|
2320 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff |
|
2321 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column. |
|
2322 % |
|
2323 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template. |
|
2324 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column. |
|
2325 % @end multitable |
|
2326 |
|
2327 % Default dimensions may be reset by user. |
|
2328 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table. |
|
2329 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table. |
|
2330 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns. |
|
2331 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline |
|
2332 % to baseline. |
|
2333 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing. |
|
2334 % |
|
2335 \newskip\multitableparskip |
|
2336 \newskip\multitableparindent |
|
2337 \newdimen\multitablecolspace |
|
2338 \newskip\multitablelinespace |
|
2339 \multitableparskip=0pt |
|
2340 \multitableparindent=6pt |
|
2341 \multitablecolspace=12pt |
|
2342 \multitablelinespace=0pt |
|
2343 |
|
2344 % Macros used to set up halign preamble: |
|
2345 % |
|
2346 \let\endsetuptable\relax |
|
2347 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable} |
|
2348 \let\columnfractions\relax |
|
2349 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions} |
|
2350 \newif\ifsetpercent |
|
2351 |
|
2352 % #1 is the part of the @columnfraction before the decimal point, which |
|
2353 % is presumably either 0 or the empty string (but we don't check, we |
|
2354 % just throw it away). #2 is the decimal part, which we use as the |
|
2355 % percent of \hsize for this column. |
|
2356 \def\pickupwholefraction#1.#2 {% |
|
2357 \global\advance\colcount by 1 |
|
2358 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{.#2\hsize}% |
|
2359 \setuptable |
|
2360 } |
|
2361 |
|
2362 \newcount\colcount |
|
2363 \def\setuptable#1{% |
|
2364 \def\firstarg{#1}% |
|
2365 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable |
|
2366 \let\go = \relax |
|
2367 \else |
|
2368 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions |
|
2369 \global\setpercenttrue |
|
2370 \else |
|
2371 \ifsetpercent |
|
2372 \let\go\pickupwholefraction |
|
2373 \else |
|
2374 \global\advance\colcount by 1 |
|
2375 \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a |
|
2376 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway. |
|
2377 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}% |
|
2378 \fi |
|
2379 \fi |
|
2380 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction |
|
2381 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so |
|
2382 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed. |
|
2383 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}% |
|
2384 \else |
|
2385 \let\go = \setuptable |
|
2386 \fi% |
|
2387 \fi |
|
2388 \go |
|
2389 } |
|
2390 |
|
2391 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions: |
|
2392 % |
|
2393 \def\multitable{\parsearg\dotable} |
|
2394 \def\dotable#1{\bgroup |
|
2395 \vskip\parskip |
|
2396 \let\item=\crcrwithfootnotes |
|
2397 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template |
|
2398 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just & until |
|
2399 % we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again. --karl, |
|
2400 % nathan@acm.org, 20apr99. |
|
2401 \let\tab=&% |
|
2402 \let\startfootins=\startsavedfootnote |
|
2403 \tolerance=9500 |
|
2404 \hbadness=9500 |
|
2405 \setmultitablespacing |
|
2406 \parskip=\multitableparskip |
|
2407 \parindent=\multitableparindent |
|
2408 \overfullrule=0pt |
|
2409 \global\colcount=0 |
|
2410 \def\Emultitable{% |
|
2411 \global\setpercentfalse |
|
2412 \crcrwithfootnotes\crcr |
|
2413 \egroup\egroup |
|
2414 }% |
|
2415 % |
|
2416 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item: |
|
2417 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable |
|
2418 % |
|
2419 % \everycr will reset column counter, \colcount, at the end of |
|
2420 % each line. Every column entry will cause \colcount to advance by one. |
|
2421 % The table preamble |
|
2422 % looks at the current \colcount to find the correct column width. |
|
2423 \everycr{\noalign{% |
|
2424 % |
|
2425 % \filbreak%% keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages. |
|
2426 % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the table |
|
2427 % breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the problem |
|
2428 % manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl. |
|
2429 \global\colcount=0\relax}}% |
|
2430 % |
|
2431 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will |
|
2432 % be used as many times as user calls for columns. |
|
2433 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and |
|
2434 % continue for many paragraphs if desired. |
|
2435 \halign\bgroup&\global\advance\colcount by 1\relax |
|
2436 \multistrut\vtop{\hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname |
|
2437 % |
|
2438 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other |
|
2439 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after |
|
2440 % the first one. |
|
2441 % |
|
2442 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace |
|
2443 % to the width of each template entry. |
|
2444 % |
|
2445 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will |
|
2446 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip |
|
2447 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at |
|
2448 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin. |
|
2449 % |
|
2450 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment. |
|
2451 \rightskip=0pt |
|
2452 \ifnum\colcount=1 |
|
2453 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text. |
|
2454 \advance\hsize by\leftskip |
|
2455 \else |
|
2456 \ifsetpercent \else |
|
2457 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize |
|
2458 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace. |
|
2459 \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace |
|
2460 \fi |
|
2461 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace: |
|
2462 \leftskip=\multitablecolspace |
|
2463 \fi |
|
2464 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious |
|
2465 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the |
|
2466 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself. |
|
2467 % For example: |
|
2468 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89 |
|
2469 % @item @code{#} |
|
2470 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country. |
|
2471 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively marking |
|
2472 % characters. |
|
2473 \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut}\cr |
|
2474 } |
|
2475 |
|
2476 \def\setmultitablespacing{% test to see if user has set \multitablelinespace. |
|
2477 % If so, do nothing. If not, give it an appropriate dimension based on |
|
2478 % current baselineskip. |
|
2479 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt |
|
2480 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip |
|
2481 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0 |
|
2482 %% strut to put in table in case some entry doesn't have descenders, |
|
2483 %% to keep lines equally spaced |
|
2484 \let\multistrut = \strut |
|
2485 \else |
|
2486 %% FIXME: what is \box0 supposed to be? |
|
2487 \gdef\multistrut{\vrule height\multitablelinespace depth\dp0 |
|
2488 width0pt\relax} \fi |
|
2489 %% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of |
|
2490 %% table. If not, do nothing. |
|
2491 %% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace. |
|
2492 \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace |
|
2493 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace |
|
2494 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller |
|
2495 %% than skip between lines in the table. |
|
2496 \fi% |
|
2497 \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt |
|
2498 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace |
|
2499 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller |
|
2500 %% than skip between lines in the table. |
|
2501 \fi} |
|
2502 |
|
2503 % In case a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote |
|
2504 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is |
|
2505 % finished. Otherwise, the insertion is lost, it never migrates to the |
|
2506 % main vertical list. --kasal, 22jan03. |
|
2507 % |
|
2508 \newbox\savedfootnotes |
|
2509 % |
|
2510 % \dotable \let's \startfootins to this, so that \dofootnote will call |
|
2511 % it instead of starting the insertion right away. |
|
2512 \def\startsavedfootnote{% |
|
2513 \global\setbox\savedfootnotes = \vbox\bgroup |
|
2514 \unvbox\savedfootnotes |
|
2515 } |
|
2516 \def\crcrwithfootnotes{% |
|
2517 \crcr |
|
2518 \ifvoid\savedfootnotes \else |
|
2519 \noalign{\insert\footins{\box\savedfootnotes}}% |
|
2520 \fi |
|
2521 } |
|
2522 |
|
2523 \message{conditionals,} |
|
2524 % Prevent errors for section commands. |
|
2525 % Used in @ignore and in failing conditionals. |
|
2526 \def\ignoresections{% |
|
2527 \let\appendix=\relax |
|
2528 \let\appendixsec=\relax |
|
2529 \let\appendixsection=\relax |
|
2530 \let\appendixsubsec=\relax |
|
2531 \let\appendixsubsection=\relax |
|
2532 \let\appendixsubsubsec=\relax |
|
2533 \let\appendixsubsubsection=\relax |
|
2534 %\let\begin=\relax |
|
2535 %\let\bye=\relax |
|
2536 \let\centerchap=\relax |
|
2537 \let\chapter=\relax |
|
2538 \let\contents=\relax |
|
2539 \let\section=\relax |
|
2540 \let\smallbook=\relax |
|
2541 \let\subsec=\relax |
|
2542 \let\subsection=\relax |
|
2543 \let\subsubsec=\relax |
|
2544 \let\subsubsection=\relax |
|
2545 \let\titlepage=\relax |
|
2546 \let\top=\relax |
|
2547 \let\unnumbered=\relax |
|
2548 \let\unnumberedsec=\relax |
|
2549 \let\unnumberedsection=\relax |
|
2550 \let\unnumberedsubsec=\relax |
|
2551 \let\unnumberedsubsection=\relax |
|
2552 \let\unnumberedsubsubsec=\relax |
|
2553 \let\unnumberedsubsubsection=\relax |
|
2554 } |
|
2555 |
|
2556 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like. |
|
2557 % |
|
2558 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}} |
|
2559 \def\documentdescriptionword{documentdescription} |
|
2560 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}} |
|
2561 \def\html{\doignore{html}} |
|
2562 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}} |
|
2563 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}} |
|
2564 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}} |
|
2565 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}} |
|
2566 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}} |
|
2567 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}} |
|
2568 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}} |
|
2569 \def\xml{\doignore{xml}} |
|
2570 |
|
2571 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file |
|
2572 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX. |
|
2573 \let\dircategory = \comment |
|
2574 |
|
2575 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals. |
|
2576 % |
|
2577 % A count to remember the depth of nesting. |
|
2578 \newcount\doignorecount \doignorecount = 0 |
|
2579 |
|
2580 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup |
|
2581 % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer. |
|
2582 \ignoresections |
|
2583 % |
|
2584 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants. |
|
2585 \catcode\spaceChar = 10 |
|
2586 % |
|
2587 % Ignore braces, so mismatched braces don't cause trouble. |
|
2588 \catcode`\{ = 9 |
|
2589 \catcode`\} = 9 |
|
2590 % |
|
2591 % Count number of #1's that we've seen. |
|
2592 \doignorecount = 0 |
|
2593 % |
|
2594 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'. |
|
2595 \expandafter \dodoignore \csname#1\endcsname {#1}% |
|
2596 } |
|
2597 |
|
2598 { \catcode`@=11 % We want to use \ST@P which cannot appear in texinfo source. |
|
2599 \obeylines % |
|
2600 % |
|
2601 \gdef\dodoignore#1#2{% |
|
2602 % #1 contains, e.g., \ifinfo, a.k.a. @ifinfo. |
|
2603 % #2 contains the string `ifinfo'. |
|
2604 % |
|
2605 % Define a command to find the next `@end #2', which must be on a line |
|
2606 % by itself. |
|
2607 \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M\end #2{\doignoretextyyy##1^^M#1\ST@P}% |
|
2608 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a |
|
2609 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for |
|
2610 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.) |
|
2611 \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M#1##2\ST@P{\doignoreyyy{##2}\ST@P}% |
|
2612 % |
|
2613 % And now expand that command. |
|
2614 \obeylines % |
|
2615 \doignoretext ^^M% |
|
2616 }% |
|
2617 } |
|
2618 |
|
2619 \def\doignoreyyy#1{% |
|
2620 \def\temp{#1}% |
|
2621 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found. |
|
2622 \let\next\doignoretextzzz |
|
2623 \else % Found a nested condition, ... |
|
2624 \advance\doignorecount by 1 |
|
2625 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another. |
|
2626 % If we're here, #1 ends with \ifinfo (for example). |
|
2627 \fi |
|
2628 \next #1% the token \ST@P is present just after this macro. |
|
2629 } |
|
2630 |
|
2631 % We have to swallow the remaining "\ST@P". |
|
2632 % |
|
2633 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{% |
|
2634 \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end. |
|
2635 \let\next\enddoignore |
|
2636 \else % Still inside a nested condition. |
|
2637 \advance\doignorecount by -1 |
|
2638 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end. |
|
2639 \fi |
|
2640 \next |
|
2641 } |
|
2642 |
|
2643 % Finish off ignored text. |
|
2644 \def\enddoignore{\endgroup\ignorespaces} |
|
2645 |
|
2646 |
|
2647 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value. |
|
2648 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE. |
|
2649 % |
|
2650 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be |
|
2651 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our |
|
2652 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we |
|
2653 % didn't need it. Make sure the catcode of space is correct to avoid |
|
2654 % losing inside @example, for instance. |
|
2655 % |
|
2656 \def\set{\begingroup\catcode` =10 |
|
2657 \catcode`\-=12 \catcode`\_=12 % Allow - and _ in VAR. |
|
2658 \parsearg\setxxx} |
|
2659 \def\setxxx#1{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy} |
|
2660 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{% |
|
2661 \def\temp{#2}% |
|
2662 \ifx\temp\empty \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname = \empty |
|
2663 \else \setzzz{#1}#2\endsetzzz % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted. |
|
2664 \fi |
|
2665 \endgroup |
|
2666 } |
|
2667 % Can't use \xdef to pre-expand #2 and save some time, since \temp or |
|
2668 % \next or other control sequences that we've defined might get us into |
|
2669 % an infinite loop. Consider `@set foo @cite{bar}'. |
|
2670 \def\setzzz#1#2 \endsetzzz{\expandafter\gdef\csname SET#1\endcsname{#2}} |
|
2671 |
|
2672 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR. |
|
2673 % |
|
2674 \def\clear{\parsearg\clearxxx} |
|
2675 \def\clearxxx#1{\global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax} |
|
2676 |
|
2677 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo. |
|
2678 { |
|
2679 \catcode`\_ = \active |
|
2680 % |
|
2681 % We might end up with active _ or - characters in the argument if |
|
2682 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}. So \let any |
|
2683 % such active characters to their normal equivalents. |
|
2684 \gdef\value{\begingroup |
|
2685 \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other |
|
2686 \indexbreaks \let_\normalunderscore |
|
2687 \valuexxx} |
|
2688 } |
|
2689 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup} |
|
2690 |
|
2691 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's |
|
2692 % properly in indexes (we \let\value to this in \indexdummies). Ones |
|
2693 % whose names contain - or _ still won't work, but we can't do anything |
|
2694 % about that. The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable |
|
2695 % is set), since the result winds up in the index file. This means that |
|
2696 % if the variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost |
|
2697 % certain it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with |
|
2698 % sufficient work to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of |
|
2699 % complete). |
|
2700 % |
|
2701 \def\expandablevalue#1{% |
|
2702 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax |
|
2703 {[No value for ``#1'']}% |
|
2704 \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}% |
|
2705 \else |
|
2706 \csname SET#1\endcsname |
|
2707 \fi |
|
2708 } |
|
2709 |
|
2710 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined |
|
2711 % with @set. |
|
2712 % |
|
2713 \def\ifset{\parsearg\doifset} |
|
2714 \def\doifset#1{% |
|
2715 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax |
|
2716 \let\next=\ifsetfail |
|
2717 \else |
|
2718 \let\next=\ifsetsucceed |
|
2719 \fi |
|
2720 \next |
|
2721 } |
|
2722 \def\ifsetsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifset}} |
|
2723 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}} |
|
2724 \defineunmatchedend{ifset} |
|
2725 |
|
2726 % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been |
|
2727 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear. |
|
2728 % |
|
2729 \def\ifclear{\parsearg\doifclear} |
|
2730 \def\doifclear#1{% |
|
2731 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax |
|
2732 \let\next=\ifclearsucceed |
|
2733 \else |
|
2734 \let\next=\ifclearfail |
|
2735 \fi |
|
2736 \next |
|
2737 } |
|
2738 \def\ifclearsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifclear}} |
|
2739 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}} |
|
2740 \defineunmatchedend{ifclear} |
|
2741 |
|
2742 % @iftex, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext always succeed; we |
|
2743 % read the text following, through the first @end iftex (etc.). Make |
|
2744 % `@end iftex' (etc.) valid only after an @iftex. |
|
2745 % |
|
2746 \def\iftex{\conditionalsucceed{iftex}} |
|
2747 \def\ifnothtml{\conditionalsucceed{ifnothtml}} |
|
2748 \def\ifnotinfo{\conditionalsucceed{ifnotinfo}} |
|
2749 \def\ifnotplaintext{\conditionalsucceed{ifnotplaintext}} |
|
2750 \defineunmatchedend{iftex} |
|
2751 \defineunmatchedend{ifnothtml} |
|
2752 \defineunmatchedend{ifnotinfo} |
|
2753 \defineunmatchedend{ifnotplaintext} |
|
2754 |
|
2755 % True conditional. Since \set globally defines its variables, we can |
|
2756 % just start and end a group (to keep the @end definition undefined at |
|
2757 % the outer level). |
|
2758 % |
|
2759 \def\conditionalsucceed#1{\begingroup |
|
2760 \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\endgroup}% |
|
2761 } |
|
2762 |
|
2763 % @defininfoenclose. |
|
2764 \let\definfoenclose=\comment |
|
2765 |
|
2766 |
|
2767 \message{indexing,} |
|
2768 % Index generation facilities |
|
2769 |
|
2770 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite |
|
2771 % except not \outer, so it can be used within \newindex. |
|
2772 {\catcode`\@=11 |
|
2773 \gdef\newwrite{\alloc@7\write\chardef\sixt@@n}} |
|
2774 |
|
2775 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo. |
|
2776 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that |
|
2777 % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo. |
|
2778 % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for |
|
2779 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo. |
|
2780 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long |
|
2781 % for the sake of vms. |
|
2782 % |
|
2783 \def\newindex#1{% |
|
2784 \iflinks |
|
2785 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname |
|
2786 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file |
|
2787 \fi |
|
2788 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index |
|
2789 \noexpand\doindex{#1}} |
|
2790 } |
|
2791 |
|
2792 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo} |
|
2793 % |
|
2794 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex} |
|
2795 |
|
2796 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code. |
|
2797 % |
|
2798 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex} |
|
2799 % |
|
2800 \def\newcodeindex#1{% |
|
2801 \iflinks |
|
2802 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname |
|
2803 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 |
|
2804 \fi |
|
2805 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% |
|
2806 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}% |
|
2807 } |
|
2808 |
|
2809 |
|
2810 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar. |
|
2811 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index. |
|
2812 % |
|
2813 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo |
|
2814 % inside @code. |
|
2815 % |
|
2816 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}} |
|
2817 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}} |
|
2818 |
|
2819 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo), |
|
2820 % #3 the target index (bar). |
|
2821 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{% |
|
2822 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up |
|
2823 % closing the target index. |
|
2824 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \undefined |
|
2825 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the |
|
2826 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files. |
|
2827 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname |
|
2828 \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1 |
|
2829 \fi |
|
2830 % redefine \fooindfile: |
|
2831 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname |
|
2832 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp |
|
2833 % redefine \fooindex: |
|
2834 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}% |
|
2835 } |
|
2836 |
|
2837 % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros. |
|
2838 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro, |
|
2839 % and it is "foo", the name of the index. |
|
2840 |
|
2841 % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work. |
|
2842 % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros. |
|
2843 |
|
2844 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic} |
|
2845 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index. |
|
2846 |
|
2847 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer} |
|
2848 \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}} |
|
2849 |
|
2850 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument. |
|
2851 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer} |
|
2852 \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}} |
|
2853 |
|
2854 % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry. |
|
2855 % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't, |
|
2856 % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't. |
|
2857 % |
|
2858 \def\indexdummies{% |
|
2859 \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files. |
|
2860 \def\ {\realbackslash\space }% |
|
2861 % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again. |
|
2862 % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes |
|
2863 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. |
|
2864 \let\{ = \mylbrace |
|
2865 \let\} = \myrbrace |
|
2866 % |
|
2867 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \realbackslash #1\space, thus |
|
2868 % effectively preventing its expansion. This is used only for control |
|
2869 % words, not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect |
|
2870 % for control characters, but is needed to separate the control word |
|
2871 % from whatever follows. |
|
2872 % |
|
2873 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the |
|
2874 % space. |
|
2875 % |
|
2876 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and |
|
2877 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then |
|
2878 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever). |
|
2879 % |
|
2880 \def\definedummyword##1{% |
|
2881 \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{\realbackslash ##1\space}% |
|
2882 }% |
|
2883 \def\definedummyletter##1{% |
|
2884 \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{\realbackslash ##1}% |
|
2885 }% |
|
2886 % |
|
2887 % Do the redefinitions. |
|
2888 \commondummies |
|
2889 } |
|
2890 |
|
2891 % For the aux file, @ is the escape character. So we want to redefine |
|
2892 % everything using @ instead of \realbackslash. When everything uses |
|
2893 % @, this will be simpler. |
|
2894 % |
|
2895 \def\atdummies{% |
|
2896 \def\@{@@}% |
|
2897 \def\ {@ }% |
|
2898 \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd |
|
2899 \let\} = \rbraceatcmd |
|
2900 % |
|
2901 % (See comments in \indexdummies.) |
|
2902 \def\definedummyword##1{% |
|
2903 \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{@##1\space}% |
|
2904 }% |
|
2905 \def\definedummyletter##1{% |
|
2906 \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{@##1}% |
|
2907 }% |
|
2908 % |
|
2909 % Do the redefinitions. |
|
2910 \commondummies |
|
2911 } |
|
2912 |
|
2913 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies. \definedummyword and |
|
2914 % \definedummyletter must be defined first. |
|
2915 % |
|
2916 \def\commondummies{% |
|
2917 % |
|
2918 \normalturnoffactive |
|
2919 % |
|
2920 % Control letters and accents. |
|
2921 \definedummyletter{_}% |
|
2922 \definedummyletter{,}% |
|
2923 \definedummyletter{"}% |
|
2924 \definedummyletter{`}% |
|
2925 \definedummyletter{'}% |
|
2926 \definedummyletter{^}% |
|
2927 \definedummyletter{~}% |
|
2928 \definedummyletter{=}% |
|
2929 \definedummyword{u}% |
|
2930 \definedummyword{v}% |
|
2931 \definedummyword{H}% |
|
2932 \definedummyword{dotaccent}% |
|
2933 \definedummyword{ringaccent}% |
|
2934 \definedummyword{tieaccent}% |
|
2935 \definedummyword{ubaraccent}% |
|
2936 \definedummyword{udotaccent}% |
|
2937 \definedummyword{dotless}% |
|
2938 % |
|
2939 % Other non-English letters. |
|
2940 \definedummyword{AA}% |
|
2941 \definedummyword{AE}% |
|
2942 \definedummyword{L}% |
|
2943 \definedummyword{OE}% |
|
2944 \definedummyword{O}% |
|
2945 \definedummyword{aa}% |
|
2946 \definedummyword{ae}% |
|
2947 \definedummyword{l}% |
|
2948 \definedummyword{oe}% |
|
2949 \definedummyword{o}% |
|
2950 \definedummyword{ss}% |
|
2951 % |
|
2952 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do. |
|
2953 \definedummyword{bf}% |
|
2954 \definedummyword{gtr}% |
|
2955 \definedummyword{hat}% |
|
2956 \definedummyword{less}% |
|
2957 \definedummyword{sf}% |
|
2958 \definedummyword{sl}% |
|
2959 \definedummyword{tclose}% |
|
2960 \definedummyword{tt}% |
|
2961 % |
|
2962 % Texinfo font commands. |
|
2963 \definedummyword{b}% |
|
2964 \definedummyword{i}% |
|
2965 \definedummyword{r}% |
|
2966 \definedummyword{sc}% |
|
2967 \definedummyword{t}% |
|
2968 % |
|
2969 \definedummyword{TeX}% |
|
2970 \definedummyword{acronym}% |
|
2971 \definedummyword{cite}% |
|
2972 \definedummyword{code}% |
|
2973 \definedummyword{command}% |
|
2974 \definedummyword{dfn}% |
|
2975 \definedummyword{dots}% |
|
2976 \definedummyword{emph}% |
|
2977 \definedummyword{env}% |
|
2978 \definedummyword{file}% |
|
2979 \definedummyword{kbd}% |
|
2980 \definedummyword{key}% |
|
2981 \definedummyword{math}% |
|
2982 \definedummyword{option}% |
|
2983 \definedummyword{samp}% |
|
2984 \definedummyword{strong}% |
|
2985 \definedummyword{uref}% |
|
2986 \definedummyword{url}% |
|
2987 \definedummyword{var}% |
|
2988 \definedummyword{w}% |
|
2989 % |
|
2990 % Assorted special characters. |
|
2991 \definedummyword{bullet}% |
|
2992 \definedummyword{copyright}% |
|
2993 \definedummyword{dots}% |
|
2994 \definedummyword{enddots}% |
|
2995 \definedummyword{equiv}% |
|
2996 \definedummyword{error}% |
|
2997 \definedummyword{expansion}% |
|
2998 \definedummyword{minus}% |
|
2999 \definedummyword{pounds}% |
|
3000 \definedummyword{point}% |
|
3001 \definedummyword{print}% |
|
3002 \definedummyword{result}% |
|
3003 % |
|
3004 % Handle some cases of @value -- where the variable name does not |
|
3005 % contain - or _, and the value does not contain any |
|
3006 % (non-fully-expandable) commands. |
|
3007 \let\value = \expandablevalue |
|
3008 % |
|
3009 % Normal spaces, not active ones. |
|
3010 \unsepspaces |
|
3011 % |
|
3012 % No macro expansion. |
|
3013 \turnoffmacros |
|
3014 } |
|
3015 |
|
3016 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces |
|
3017 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the |
|
3018 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ). |
|
3019 {\obeyspaces |
|
3020 \gdef\unsepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\space}} |
|
3021 |
|
3022 |
|
3023 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index |
|
3024 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all |
|
3025 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string |
|
3026 % would be for a given command (usually its argument). |
|
3027 % |
|
3028 \def\indexdummytex{TeX} |
|
3029 \def\indexdummydots{...} |
|
3030 % |
|
3031 \def\indexnofonts{% |
|
3032 \def\ { }% |
|
3033 \def\@{@}% |
|
3034 % how to handle braces? |
|
3035 \def\_{\normalunderscore}% |
|
3036 % |
|
3037 \let\,=\asis |
|
3038 \let\"=\asis |
|
3039 \let\`=\asis |
|
3040 \let\'=\asis |
|
3041 \let\^=\asis |
|
3042 \let\~=\asis |
|
3043 \let\==\asis |
|
3044 \let\u=\asis |
|
3045 \let\v=\asis |
|
3046 \let\H=\asis |
|
3047 \let\dotaccent=\asis |
|
3048 \let\ringaccent=\asis |
|
3049 \let\tieaccent=\asis |
|
3050 \let\ubaraccent=\asis |
|
3051 \let\udotaccent=\asis |
|
3052 \let\dotless=\asis |
|
3053 % |
|
3054 % Other non-English letters. |
|
3055 \def\AA{AA}% |
|
3056 \def\AE{AE}% |
|
3057 \def\L{L}% |
|
3058 \def\OE{OE}% |
|
3059 \def\O{O}% |
|
3060 \def\aa{aa}% |
|
3061 \def\ae{ae}% |
|
3062 \def\l{l}% |
|
3063 \def\oe{oe}% |
|
3064 \def\o{o}% |
|
3065 \def\ss{ss}% |
|
3066 \def\exclamdown{!}% |
|
3067 \def\questiondown{?}% |
|
3068 % |
|
3069 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command |
|
3070 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc. |
|
3071 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands. |
|
3072 %\let\tt=\asis |
|
3073 % |
|
3074 % Texinfo font commands. |
|
3075 \let\b=\asis |
|
3076 \let\i=\asis |
|
3077 \let\r=\asis |
|
3078 \let\sc=\asis |
|
3079 \let\t=\asis |
|
3080 % |
|
3081 \let\TeX=\indexdummytex |
|
3082 \let\acronym=\asis |
|
3083 \let\cite=\asis |
|
3084 \let\code=\asis |
|
3085 \let\command=\asis |
|
3086 \let\dfn=\asis |
|
3087 \let\dots=\indexdummydots |
|
3088 \let\emph=\asis |
|
3089 \let\env=\asis |
|
3090 \let\file=\asis |
|
3091 \let\kbd=\asis |
|
3092 \let\key=\asis |
|
3093 \let\math=\asis |
|
3094 \let\option=\asis |
|
3095 \let\samp=\asis |
|
3096 \let\strong=\asis |
|
3097 \let\uref=\asis |
|
3098 \let\url=\asis |
|
3099 \let\var=\asis |
|
3100 \let\w=\asis |
|
3101 } |
|
3102 |
|
3103 \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex. |
|
3104 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)? |
|
3105 |
|
3106 % For \ifx comparisons. |
|
3107 \def\emptymacro{\empty} |
|
3108 |
|
3109 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case. |
|
3110 % |
|
3111 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}\empty} |
|
3112 |
|
3113 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes. |
|
3114 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry -- |
|
3115 % \empty if called from \doind, as we usually are. The main exception |
|
3116 % is with defuns, which call us directly. |
|
3117 % |
|
3118 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{% |
|
3119 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired. |
|
3120 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else |
|
3121 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt #2}}% |
|
3122 \fi |
|
3123 {% |
|
3124 \count255=\lastpenalty |
|
3125 {% |
|
3126 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage |
|
3127 \escapechar=`\\ |
|
3128 {% |
|
3129 \let\folio = 0% We will expand all macros now EXCEPT \folio. |
|
3130 \def\rawbackslashxx{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now |
|
3131 % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash. |
|
3132 % |
|
3133 % The main index entry text. |
|
3134 \toks0 = {#2}% |
|
3135 % |
|
3136 % If third arg is present, precede it with space in sort key. |
|
3137 \def\thirdarg{#3}% |
|
3138 \ifx\thirdarg\emptymacro \else |
|
3139 % If the third (subentry) arg is present, add it to the index |
|
3140 % line to write. |
|
3141 \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}% |
|
3142 \fi |
|
3143 % |
|
3144 % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to |
|
3145 % get the string to sort by. |
|
3146 {\indexnofonts |
|
3147 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion |
|
3148 \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}% |
|
3149 }% |
|
3150 % |
|
3151 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and |
|
3152 % the original text, including any font commands. We write |
|
3153 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the |
|
3154 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s |
|
3155 % sorted result. |
|
3156 \edef\temp{% |
|
3157 \write\csname#1indfile\endcsname{% |
|
3158 \realbackslash entry{\indexsorttmp}{\folio}{\the\toks0}}% |
|
3159 }% |
|
3160 % |
|
3161 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it |
|
3162 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting |
|
3163 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the |
|
3164 % \write will make \lastskip zero. The result is that sequences |
|
3165 % like this: |
|
3166 % @end defun |
|
3167 % @tindex whatever |
|
3168 % @defun ... |
|
3169 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the |
|
3170 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of |
|
3171 % the previous defun. |
|
3172 % |
|
3173 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We |
|
3174 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph. |
|
3175 % |
|
3176 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too. |
|
3177 % |
|
3178 \iflinks |
|
3179 \ifvmode |
|
3180 \skip0 = \lastskip |
|
3181 \ifdim\lastskip = 0pt \else \nobreak\vskip-\skip0 \fi |
|
3182 \fi |
|
3183 % |
|
3184 \temp % do the write |
|
3185 % |
|
3186 \ifvmode \ifdim\skip0 = 0pt \else \nobreak\vskip\skip0 \fi \fi |
|
3187 \fi |
|
3188 }% |
|
3189 }% |
|
3190 \penalty\count255 |
|
3191 }% |
|
3192 } |
|
3193 |
|
3194 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like |
|
3195 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic} |
|
3196 % or |
|
3197 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic} |
|
3198 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files |
|
3199 % containing these kinds of lines: |
|
3200 % \initial {c} |
|
3201 % before the first topic whose initial is c |
|
3202 % \entry {topic}{pagelist} |
|
3203 % for a topic that is used without subtopics |
|
3204 % \primary {topic} |
|
3205 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics |
|
3206 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist} |
|
3207 % for each subtopic. |
|
3208 |
|
3209 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands |
|
3210 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex. |
|
3211 |
|
3212 \def\findex {\fnindex} |
|
3213 \def\kindex {\kyindex} |
|
3214 \def\cindex {\cpindex} |
|
3215 \def\vindex {\vrindex} |
|
3216 \def\tindex {\tpindex} |
|
3217 \def\pindex {\pgindex} |
|
3218 |
|
3219 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub} |
|
3220 {\obeylines % |
|
3221 \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup % |
|
3222 \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}} |
|
3223 |
|
3224 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material. |
|
3225 |
|
3226 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed. |
|
3227 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered). |
|
3228 % |
|
3229 \def\printindex{\parsearg\doprintindex} |
|
3230 \def\doprintindex#1{\begingroup |
|
3231 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}% |
|
3232 % |
|
3233 \smallfonts \rm |
|
3234 \tolerance = 9500 |
|
3235 \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression. |
|
3236 \indexbreaks |
|
3237 % |
|
3238 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty. |
|
3239 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains |
|
3240 % \initial {@} |
|
3241 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces |
|
3242 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence). |
|
3243 \catcode`\@ = 11 |
|
3244 \openin 1 \jobname.#1s |
|
3245 \ifeof 1 |
|
3246 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index, |
|
3247 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the |
|
3248 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure |
|
3249 % there is some text. |
|
3250 \putwordIndexNonexistent |
|
3251 \else |
|
3252 % |
|
3253 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof |
|
3254 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so |
|
3255 % it can discover if there is anything in it. |
|
3256 \read 1 to \temp |
|
3257 \ifeof 1 |
|
3258 \putwordIndexIsEmpty |
|
3259 \else |
|
3260 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape |
|
3261 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change |
|
3262 % to make right now. |
|
3263 \def\indexbackslash{\rawbackslashxx}% |
|
3264 \catcode`\\ = 0 |
|
3265 \escapechar = `\\ |
|
3266 \begindoublecolumns |
|
3267 \input \jobname.#1s |
|
3268 \enddoublecolumns |
|
3269 \fi |
|
3270 \fi |
|
3271 \closein 1 |
|
3272 \endgroup} |
|
3273 |
|
3274 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself. |
|
3275 % Change them to control the appearance of the index. |
|
3276 |
|
3277 \def\initial#1{{% |
|
3278 % Some minor font changes for the special characters. |
|
3279 \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt |
|
3280 % |
|
3281 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own. |
|
3282 \removelastskip |
|
3283 % |
|
3284 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus. |
|
3285 \penalty -300 |
|
3286 % |
|
3287 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of |
|
3288 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column |
|
3289 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch |
|
3290 % we need before each entry, but it's better. |
|
3291 % |
|
3292 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns. |
|
3293 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip |
|
3294 \leftline{\secbf #1}% |
|
3295 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip |
|
3296 % |
|
3297 % Do our best not to break after the initial. |
|
3298 \nobreak |
|
3299 }} |
|
3300 |
|
3301 % This typesets a paragraph consisting of #1, dot leaders, and then #2 |
|
3302 % flush to the right margin. It is used for index and table of contents |
|
3303 % entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip. |
|
3304 % |
|
3305 \def\entry#1#2{\begingroup |
|
3306 % |
|
3307 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't |
|
3308 % affect previous text. |
|
3309 \par |
|
3310 % |
|
3311 % Do not fill out the last line with white space. |
|
3312 \parfillskip = 0in |
|
3313 % |
|
3314 % No extra space above this paragraph. |
|
3315 \parskip = 0in |
|
3316 % |
|
3317 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines. |
|
3318 \finalhyphendemerits = 0 |
|
3319 % |
|
3320 % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number |
|
3321 % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the |
|
3322 % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large |
|
3323 % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across |
|
3324 % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders. |
|
3325 % |
|
3326 % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start |
|
3327 % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that. |
|
3328 \hangindent = 2em |
|
3329 % |
|
3330 % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line |
|
3331 % with blank space. |
|
3332 \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil |
|
3333 % |
|
3334 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing columns. |
|
3335 \vskip 0pt plus1pt |
|
3336 % |
|
3337 % Start a ``paragraph'' for the index entry so the line breaking |
|
3338 % parameters we've set above will have an effect. |
|
3339 \noindent |
|
3340 % |
|
3341 % Insert the text of the index entry. TeX will do line-breaking on it. |
|
3342 #1% |
|
3343 % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if |
|
3344 % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be |
|
3345 % cursed by a Unix daemon. |
|
3346 \def\tempa{{\rm }}% |
|
3347 \def\tempb{#2}% |
|
3348 \edef\tempc{\tempa}% |
|
3349 \edef\tempd{\tempb}% |
|
3350 \ifx\tempc\tempd\ \else% |
|
3351 % |
|
3352 % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out |
|
3353 % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the |
|
3354 % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.) |
|
3355 \hfil\penalty50 |
|
3356 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number. |
|
3357 % |
|
3358 % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as |
|
3359 % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull |
|
3360 % \hbox ensues. |
|
3361 \ifpdf |
|
3362 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph. |
|
3363 \else |
|
3364 \ #2% The page number ends the paragraph. |
|
3365 \fi |
|
3366 \fi% |
|
3367 \par |
|
3368 \endgroup} |
|
3369 |
|
3370 % Like \dotfill except takes at least 1 em. |
|
3371 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders |
|
3372 \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu ${\it .}$ \mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill} |
|
3373 |
|
3374 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}} |
|
3375 |
|
3376 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm |
|
3377 \def\secondary#1#2{{% |
|
3378 \parfillskip=0in |
|
3379 \parskip=0in |
|
3380 \hangindent=1in |
|
3381 \hangafter=1 |
|
3382 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill |
|
3383 \ifpdf |
|
3384 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph. |
|
3385 \else |
|
3386 #2 |
|
3387 \fi |
|
3388 \par |
|
3389 }} |
|
3390 |
|
3391 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes. |
|
3392 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say, |
|
3393 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself. |
|
3394 \catcode`\@=11 |
|
3395 |
|
3396 \newbox\partialpage |
|
3397 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize |
|
3398 |
|
3399 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns |
|
3400 % Grab any single-column material above us. |
|
3401 \output = {% |
|
3402 % |
|
3403 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a |
|
3404 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output |
|
3405 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is |
|
3406 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In |
|
3407 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal |
|
3408 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this |
|
3409 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case. |
|
3410 \ifvoid\partialpage \else |
|
3411 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}% |
|
3412 \fi |
|
3413 % |
|
3414 \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{% |
|
3415 % Unvbox the main output page. |
|
3416 \unvbox\PAGE |
|
3417 \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip |
|
3418 }% |
|
3419 }% |
|
3420 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage |
|
3421 % |
|
3422 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages. |
|
3423 \output = {\doublecolumnout}% |
|
3424 % |
|
3425 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this |
|
3426 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11 |
|
3427 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple |
|
3428 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the |
|
3429 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place. |
|
3430 % |
|
3431 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between |
|
3432 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it |
|
3433 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant |
|
3434 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt) |
|
3435 % as it did when we hard-coded it. |
|
3436 % |
|
3437 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we |
|
3438 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially) |
|
3439 % been clobbered. |
|
3440 % |
|
3441 \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize |
|
3442 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize |
|
3443 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2 |
|
3444 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize |
|
3445 % |
|
3446 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here, |
|
3447 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.) |
|
3448 \vsize = 2\vsize |
|
3449 } |
|
3450 |
|
3451 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except |
|
3452 % the last. |
|
3453 % |
|
3454 \def\doublecolumnout{% |
|
3455 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth |
|
3456 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal |
|
3457 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the |
|
3458 % previous page. |
|
3459 \dimen@ = \vsize |
|
3460 \divide\dimen@ by 2 |
|
3461 \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage |
|
3462 % |
|
3463 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right. |
|
3464 \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ |
|
3465 \onepageout\pagesofar |
|
3466 \unvbox255 |
|
3467 \penalty\outputpenalty |
|
3468 } |
|
3469 % |
|
3470 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material, |
|
3471 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2. |
|
3472 \def\pagesofar{% |
|
3473 \unvbox\partialpage |
|
3474 % |
|
3475 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize |
|
3476 \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize |
|
3477 \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}% |
|
3478 } |
|
3479 % |
|
3480 % All done with double columns. |
|
3481 \def\enddoublecolumns{% |
|
3482 \output = {% |
|
3483 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the |
|
3484 % current page, no automatic page break. |
|
3485 \balancecolumns |
|
3486 % |
|
3487 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page, |
|
3488 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output |
|
3489 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not |
|
3490 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal |
|
3491 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be |
|
3492 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes |
|
3493 % the output somewhat more palatable.) |
|
3494 \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}% |
|
3495 }% |
|
3496 \eject |
|
3497 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns |
|
3498 % |
|
3499 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted |
|
3500 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column |
|
3501 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the |
|
3502 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored). |
|
3503 \pagegoal = \vsize |
|
3504 } |
|
3505 % |
|
3506 % Called at the end of the double column material. |
|
3507 \def\balancecolumns{% |
|
3508 \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120. |
|
3509 \dimen@ = \ht0 |
|
3510 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip |
|
3511 \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip |
|
3512 \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to |
|
3513 %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}% |
|
3514 \splittopskip = \topskip |
|
3515 % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint. |
|
3516 {% |
|
3517 \vbadness = 10000 |
|
3518 \loop |
|
3519 \global\setbox3 = \copy0 |
|
3520 \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@ |
|
3521 \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@ |
|
3522 \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt |
|
3523 \repeat |
|
3524 }% |
|
3525 %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}% |
|
3526 \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}% |
|
3527 \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}% |
|
3528 % |
|
3529 \pagesofar |
|
3530 } |
|
3531 \catcode`\@ = \other |
|
3532 |
|
3533 |
|
3534 \message{sectioning,} |
|
3535 % Chapters, sections, etc. |
|
3536 |
|
3537 \newcount\chapno |
|
3538 \newcount\secno \secno=0 |
|
3539 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0 |
|
3540 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0 |
|
3541 |
|
3542 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ... |
|
3543 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@ |
|
3544 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno} |
|
3545 % We do the following for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual |
|
3546 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset. |
|
3547 \def\appendixletter{% |
|
3548 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A% |
|
3549 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B% |
|
3550 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C% |
|
3551 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D% |
|
3552 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E% |
|
3553 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F% |
|
3554 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G% |
|
3555 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H% |
|
3556 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I% |
|
3557 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J% |
|
3558 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K% |
|
3559 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L% |
|
3560 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M% |
|
3561 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N% |
|
3562 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O% |
|
3563 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P% |
|
3564 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q% |
|
3565 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R% |
|
3566 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S% |
|
3567 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T% |
|
3568 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U% |
|
3569 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V% |
|
3570 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W% |
|
3571 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X% |
|
3572 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y% |
|
3573 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z% |
|
3574 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is |
|
3575 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not |
|
3576 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out |
|
3577 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it. |
|
3578 \else\char\the\appendixno |
|
3579 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi |
|
3580 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi} |
|
3581 |
|
3582 % Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter. |
|
3583 % page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise. |
|
3584 \def\thischapter{} |
|
3585 \def\thissection{} |
|
3586 |
|
3587 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level |
|
3588 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raise/lowersections modify this count |
|
3589 |
|
3590 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc. |
|
3591 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1} |
|
3592 \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name |
|
3593 |
|
3594 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc. |
|
3595 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1} |
|
3596 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name |
|
3597 |
|
3598 % Choose a numbered-heading macro |
|
3599 % #1 is heading level if unmodified by @raisesections or @lowersections |
|
3600 % #2 is text for heading |
|
3601 \def\numhead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1 |
|
3602 \ifcase\absseclevel |
|
3603 \chapterzzz{#2} |
|
3604 \or |
|
3605 \seczzz{#2} |
|
3606 \or |
|
3607 \numberedsubseczzz{#2} |
|
3608 \or |
|
3609 \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2} |
|
3610 \else |
|
3611 \ifnum \absseclevel<0 |
|
3612 \chapterzzz{#2} |
|
3613 \else |
|
3614 \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2} |
|
3615 \fi |
|
3616 \fi |
|
3617 \suppressfirstparagraphindent |
|
3618 } |
|
3619 |
|
3620 % like \numhead, but chooses appendix heading levels |
|
3621 \def\apphead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1 |
|
3622 \ifcase\absseclevel |
|
3623 \appendixzzz{#2} |
|
3624 \or |
|
3625 \appendixsectionzzz{#2} |
|
3626 \or |
|
3627 \appendixsubseczzz{#2} |
|
3628 \or |
|
3629 \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2} |
|
3630 \else |
|
3631 \ifnum \absseclevel<0 |
|
3632 \appendixzzz{#2} |
|
3633 \else |
|
3634 \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2} |
|
3635 \fi |
|
3636 \fi |
|
3637 \suppressfirstparagraphindent |
|
3638 } |
|
3639 |
|
3640 % like \numhead, but chooses numberless heading levels |
|
3641 \def\unnmhead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1 |
|
3642 \ifcase\absseclevel |
|
3643 \unnumberedzzz{#2} |
|
3644 \or |
|
3645 \unnumberedseczzz{#2} |
|
3646 \or |
|
3647 \unnumberedsubseczzz{#2} |
|
3648 \or |
|
3649 \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2} |
|
3650 \else |
|
3651 \ifnum \absseclevel<0 |
|
3652 \unnumberedzzz{#2} |
|
3653 \else |
|
3654 \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2} |
|
3655 \fi |
|
3656 \fi |
|
3657 \suppressfirstparagraphindent |
|
3658 } |
|
3659 |
|
3660 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. |
|
3661 \def\thischaptername{No Chapter Title} |
|
3662 \outer\def\chapter{\parsearg\chapteryyy} |
|
3663 \def\chapteryyy #1{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz |
|
3664 \def\chapterzzz #1{% |
|
3665 \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 |
|
3666 \global\advance \chapno by 1 \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}% |
|
3667 \chapmacro {#1}{\the\chapno}% |
|
3668 \gdef\thissection{#1}% |
|
3669 \gdef\thischaptername{#1}% |
|
3670 % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter |
|
3671 % because we don't want its macros evaluated now. |
|
3672 \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno: \noexpand\thischaptername}% |
|
3673 \writetocentry{chap}{#1}{{\the\chapno}} |
|
3674 \donoderef |
|
3675 \global\let\section = \numberedsec |
|
3676 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec |
|
3677 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec |
|
3678 } |
|
3679 |
|
3680 % we use \chapno to avoid indenting back |
|
3681 \def\appendixbox#1{% |
|
3682 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} \the\chapno}% |
|
3683 \hbox to \wd0{#1\hss}} |
|
3684 |
|
3685 \outer\def\appendix{\parsearg\appendixyyy} |
|
3686 \def\appendixyyy #1{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz |
|
3687 \def\appendixzzz #1{% |
|
3688 \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 |
|
3689 \global\advance \appendixno by 1 |
|
3690 \message{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}% |
|
3691 \chapmacro {#1}{\appendixbox{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter}}% |
|
3692 \gdef\thissection{#1}% |
|
3693 \gdef\thischaptername{#1}% |
|
3694 \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter: \noexpand\thischaptername}% |
|
3695 \writetocentry{appendix}{#1}{{\appendixletter}} |
|
3696 \appendixnoderef |
|
3697 \global\let\section = \appendixsec |
|
3698 \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec |
|
3699 \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec |
|
3700 } |
|
3701 |
|
3702 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered. |
|
3703 \outer\def\centerchap{\parsearg\centerchapyyy} |
|
3704 \def\centerchapyyy #1{{\let\unnumbchapmacro=\centerchapmacro \unnumberedyyy{#1}}} |
|
3705 |
|
3706 % @top is like @unnumbered. |
|
3707 \outer\def\top{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy} |
|
3708 |
|
3709 \outer\def\unnumbered{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy} |
|
3710 \def\unnumberedyyy #1{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz |
|
3711 \def\unnumberedzzz #1{% |
|
3712 \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 |
|
3713 % |
|
3714 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the |
|
3715 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX |
|
3716 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX |
|
3717 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant |
|
3718 % to be executed, not expanded). |
|
3719 % |
|
3720 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear |
|
3721 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use |
|
3722 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once, |
|
3723 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for |
|
3724 % the toc entries.) |
|
3725 \toks0 = {#1}\message{(\the\toks0)}% |
|
3726 % |
|
3727 \unnumbchapmacro {#1}% |
|
3728 \gdef\thischapter{#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% |
|
3729 \writetocentry{unnumbchap}{#1}{{\the\chapno}} |
|
3730 \unnumbnoderef |
|
3731 \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec |
|
3732 \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec |
|
3733 \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec |
|
3734 } |
|
3735 |
|
3736 % Sections. |
|
3737 \outer\def\numberedsec{\parsearg\secyyy} |
|
3738 \def\secyyy #1{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz |
|
3739 \def\seczzz #1{% |
|
3740 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \secno by 1 % |
|
3741 \gdef\thissection{#1}\secheading {#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}% |
|
3742 \writetocentry{sec}{#1}{{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}} |
|
3743 \donoderef |
|
3744 \nobreak |
|
3745 } |
|
3746 |
|
3747 \outer\def\appendixsection{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy} |
|
3748 \outer\def\appendixsec{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy} |
|
3749 \def\appendixsecyyy #1{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz |
|
3750 \def\appendixsectionzzz #1{% |
|
3751 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \secno by 1 % |
|
3752 \gdef\thissection{#1}\secheading {#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}% |
|
3753 \writetocentry{sec}{#1}{{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}} |
|
3754 \appendixnoderef |
|
3755 \nobreak |
|
3756 } |
|
3757 |
|
3758 \outer\def\unnumberedsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsecyyy} |
|
3759 \def\unnumberedsecyyy #1{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz |
|
3760 \def\unnumberedseczzz #1{% |
|
3761 \plainsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% |
|
3762 \writetocentry{unnumbsec}{#1}{{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}} |
|
3763 \unnumbnoderef |
|
3764 \nobreak |
|
3765 } |
|
3766 |
|
3767 % Subsections. |
|
3768 \outer\def\numberedsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsecyyy} |
|
3769 \def\numberedsubsecyyy #1{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz |
|
3770 \def\numberedsubseczzz #1{% |
|
3771 \gdef\thissection{#1}\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \subsecno by 1 % |
|
3772 \subsecheading {#1}{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}% |
|
3773 \writetocentry{subsec}{#1}{{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}} |
|
3774 \donoderef |
|
3775 \nobreak |
|
3776 } |
|
3777 |
|
3778 \outer\def\appendixsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsecyyy} |
|
3779 \def\appendixsubsecyyy #1{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz |
|
3780 \def\appendixsubseczzz #1{% |
|
3781 \gdef\thissection{#1}\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance \subsecno by 1 % |
|
3782 \subsecheading {#1}{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}% |
|
3783 \writetocentry{subsec}{#1}{{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}} |
|
3784 \appendixnoderef |
|
3785 \nobreak |
|
3786 } |
|
3787 |
|
3788 \outer\def\unnumberedsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsecyyy} |
|
3789 \def\unnumberedsubsecyyy #1{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz |
|
3790 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz #1{% |
|
3791 \plainsubsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% |
|
3792 \writetocentry{unnumbsubsec}{#1}{{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}} |
|
3793 \unnumbnoderef |
|
3794 \nobreak |
|
3795 } |
|
3796 |
|
3797 % Subsubsections. |
|
3798 \outer\def\numberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsubsecyyy} |
|
3799 \def\numberedsubsubsecyyy #1{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz |
|
3800 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz #1{% |
|
3801 \gdef\thissection{#1}\global\advance \subsubsecno by 1 % |
|
3802 \subsubsecheading {#1} |
|
3803 {\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}% |
|
3804 \writetocentry{subsubsec}{#1}{{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}} |
|
3805 \donoderef |
|
3806 \nobreak |
|
3807 } |
|
3808 |
|
3809 \outer\def\appendixsubsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsubsecyyy} |
|
3810 \def\appendixsubsubsecyyy #1{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz |
|
3811 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz #1{% |
|
3812 \gdef\thissection{#1}\global\advance \subsubsecno by 1 % |
|
3813 \subsubsecheading {#1} |
|
3814 {\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}% |
|
3815 \writetocentry{subsubsec}{#1}{{\appendixletter}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}} |
|
3816 \appendixnoderef |
|
3817 \nobreak |
|
3818 } |
|
3819 |
|
3820 \outer\def\unnumberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy} |
|
3821 \def\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy #1{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz |
|
3822 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz #1{% |
|
3823 \plainsubsubsecheading {#1}\gdef\thissection{#1}% |
|
3824 \writetocentry{unnumbsubsubsec}{#1}{{\the\chapno}{\the\secno}{\the\subsecno}{\the\subsubsecno}} |
|
3825 \unnumbnoderef |
|
3826 \nobreak |
|
3827 } |
|
3828 |
|
3829 % These are variants which are not "outer", so they can appear in @ifinfo. |
|
3830 % Actually, they should now be obsolete; ordinary section commands should work. |
|
3831 \def\infotop{\parsearg\unnumberedzzz} |
|
3832 \def\infounnumbered{\parsearg\unnumberedzzz} |
|
3833 \def\infounnumberedsec{\parsearg\unnumberedseczzz} |
|
3834 \def\infounnumberedsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubseczzz} |
|
3835 \def\infounnumberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsubseczzz} |
|
3836 |
|
3837 \def\infoappendix{\parsearg\appendixzzz} |
|
3838 \def\infoappendixsec{\parsearg\appendixseczzz} |
|
3839 \def\infoappendixsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubseczzz} |
|
3840 \def\infoappendixsubsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsubseczzz} |
|
3841 |
|
3842 \def\infochapter{\parsearg\chapterzzz} |
|
3843 \def\infosection{\parsearg\sectionzzz} |
|
3844 \def\infosubsection{\parsearg\subsectionzzz} |
|
3845 \def\infosubsubsection{\parsearg\subsubsectionzzz} |
|
3846 |
|
3847 % These macros control what the section commands do, according |
|
3848 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered). |
|
3849 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter. |
|
3850 \global\let\section = \numberedsec |
|
3851 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec |
|
3852 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec |
|
3853 |
|
3854 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading |
|
3855 |
|
3856 % NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such: |
|
3857 % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit |
|
3858 % overlong headings to fold. |
|
3859 % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a |
|
3860 % heading is obnoxious; this forbids it. |
|
3861 % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and |
|
3862 % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright. |
|
3863 |
|
3864 |
|
3865 \def\majorheading{% |
|
3866 {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }% |
|
3867 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz |
|
3868 } |
|
3869 |
|
3870 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz} |
|
3871 \def\chapheadingzzz #1{% |
|
3872 {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 |
|
3873 \parindent=0pt\raggedright |
|
3874 \rm #1\hfill}}% |
|
3875 \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax |
|
3876 \suppressfirstparagraphindent |
|
3877 } |
|
3878 |
|
3879 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading. |
|
3880 \def\heading{\parsearg\doheading} |
|
3881 \def\subheading{\parsearg\dosubheading} |
|
3882 \def\subsubheading{\parsearg\dosubsubheading} |
|
3883 \def\doheading#1{\plainsecheading{#1}\suppressfirstparagraphindent} |
|
3884 \def\dosubheading#1{\plainsubsecheading{#1}\suppressfirstparagraphindent} |
|
3885 \def\dosubsubheading#1{\plainsubsubsecheading{#1}\suppressfirstparagraphindent} |
|
3886 |
|
3887 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only |
|
3888 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it), |
|
3889 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form. |
|
3890 |
|
3891 %%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative) |
|
3892 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi} |
|
3893 |
|
3894 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname} |
|
3895 |
|
3896 %%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it |
|
3897 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed) |
|
3898 |
|
3899 \newskip\chapheadingskip |
|
3900 |
|
3901 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}} |
|
3902 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject} |
|
3903 \def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to 0pt{} \chappager\fi} |
|
3904 |
|
3905 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname} |
|
3906 |
|
3907 \def\CHAPPAGoff{% |
|
3908 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
|
3909 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak |
|
3910 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager} |
|
3911 |
|
3912 \def\CHAPPAGon{% |
|
3913 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
|
3914 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager |
|
3915 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager |
|
3916 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}} |
|
3917 |
|
3918 \def\CHAPPAGodd{ |
|
3919 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage |
|
3920 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage |
|
3921 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage |
|
3922 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}} |
|
3923 |
|
3924 \CHAPPAGon |
|
3925 |
|
3926 \def\CHAPFplain{ |
|
3927 \global\let\chapmacro=\chfplain |
|
3928 \global\let\unnumbchapmacro=\unnchfplain |
|
3929 \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfplain} |
|
3930 |
|
3931 % Plain chapter opening. |
|
3932 % #1 is the text, #2 the chapter number or empty if unnumbered. |
|
3933 \def\chfplain#1#2{% |
|
3934 \pchapsepmacro |
|
3935 {% |
|
3936 \chapfonts \rm |
|
3937 \def\chapnum{#2}% |
|
3938 \setbox0 = \hbox{#2\ifx\chapnum\empty\else\enspace\fi}% |
|
3939 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright |
|
3940 \hangindent = \wd0 \centerparametersmaybe |
|
3941 \unhbox0 #1\par}% |
|
3942 }% |
|
3943 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title |
|
3944 \nobreak |
|
3945 } |
|
3946 |
|
3947 % Plain opening for unnumbered. |
|
3948 \def\unnchfplain#1{\chfplain{#1}{}} |
|
3949 |
|
3950 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered. |
|
3951 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax |
|
3952 \def\centerchfplain#1{{% |
|
3953 \def\centerparametersmaybe{% |
|
3954 \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip |
|
3955 \leftskip = \rightskip |
|
3956 \parfillskip = 0pt |
|
3957 }% |
|
3958 \chfplain{#1}{}% |
|
3959 }} |
|
3960 |
|
3961 \CHAPFplain % The default |
|
3962 |
|
3963 \def\unnchfopen #1{% |
|
3964 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 |
|
3965 \parindent=0pt\raggedright |
|
3966 \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak |
|
3967 } |
|
3968 |
|
3969 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts |
|
3970 \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}% |
|
3971 \par\penalty 5000 % |
|
3972 } |
|
3973 |
|
3974 \def\centerchfopen #1{% |
|
3975 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 |
|
3976 \parindent=0pt |
|
3977 \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak |
|
3978 } |
|
3979 |
|
3980 \def\CHAPFopen{ |
|
3981 \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen |
|
3982 \global\let\unnumbchapmacro=\unnchfopen |
|
3983 \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen} |
|
3984 |
|
3985 |
|
3986 % Section titles. |
|
3987 \newskip\secheadingskip |
|
3988 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip {-1000}} |
|
3989 \def\secheading#1#2#3{\sectionheading{sec}{#2.#3}{#1}} |
|
3990 \def\plainsecheading#1{\sectionheading{sec}{}{#1}} |
|
3991 |
|
3992 % Subsection titles. |
|
3993 \newskip \subsecheadingskip |
|
3994 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip {-500}} |
|
3995 \def\subsecheading#1#2#3#4{\sectionheading{subsec}{#2.#3.#4}{#1}} |
|
3996 \def\plainsubsecheading#1{\sectionheading{subsec}{}{#1}} |
|
3997 |
|
3998 % Subsubsection titles. |
|
3999 \let\subsubsecheadingskip = \subsecheadingskip |
|
4000 \let\subsubsecheadingbreak = \subsecheadingbreak |
|
4001 \def\subsubsecheading#1#2#3#4#5{\sectionheading{subsubsec}{#2.#3.#4.#5}{#1}} |
|
4002 \def\plainsubsubsecheading#1{\sectionheading{subsubsec}{}{#1}} |
|
4003 |
|
4004 |
|
4005 % Print any size section title. |
|
4006 % |
|
4007 % #1 is the section type (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #2 is the section |
|
4008 % number (maybe empty), #3 the text. |
|
4009 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3{% |
|
4010 {% |
|
4011 \expandafter\advance\csname #1headingskip\endcsname by \parskip |
|
4012 \csname #1headingbreak\endcsname |
|
4013 }% |
|
4014 {% |
|
4015 % Switch to the right set of fonts. |
|
4016 \csname #1fonts\endcsname \rm |
|
4017 % |
|
4018 % Only insert the separating space if we have a section number. |
|
4019 \def\secnum{#2}% |
|
4020 \setbox0 = \hbox{#2\ifx\secnum\empty\else\enspace\fi}% |
|
4021 % |
|
4022 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright |
|
4023 \hangindent = \wd0 % zero if no section number |
|
4024 \unhbox0 #3}% |
|
4025 }% |
|
4026 % Add extra space after the heading -- either a line space or a |
|
4027 % paragraph space, whichever is more. (Some people like to set |
|
4028 % \parskip to large values for some reason.) Don't allow stretch, though. |
|
4029 \nobreak |
|
4030 \ifdim\parskip>\normalbaselineskip |
|
4031 \kern\parskip |
|
4032 \else |
|
4033 \kern\normalbaselineskip |
|
4034 \fi |
|
4035 \nobreak |
|
4036 } |
|
4037 |
|
4038 |
|
4039 \message{toc,} |
|
4040 % Table of contents. |
|
4041 \newwrite\tocfile |
|
4042 |
|
4043 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary. |
|
4044 % Called from @chapter, etc. We supply {\folio} at the end of the |
|
4045 % argument, which will end up as the last argument to the \...entry macro. |
|
4046 % |
|
4047 % Usage: \writetocentry{chap}{The Name of The Game}{{\the\chapno}} |
|
4048 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or |
|
4049 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document. |
|
4050 % |
|
4051 \newif\iftocfileopened |
|
4052 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{% |
|
4053 \iftocfileopened\else |
|
4054 \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc |
|
4055 \global\tocfileopenedtrue |
|
4056 \fi |
|
4057 % |
|
4058 \iflinks |
|
4059 \toks0 = {#2}% |
|
4060 \edef\temp{\write\tocfile{\realbackslash #1entry{\the\toks0}#3{\folio}}}% |
|
4061 \temp |
|
4062 \fi |
|
4063 % |
|
4064 % Tell \shipout to create a page destination if we're doing pdf, which |
|
4065 % will be the target of the links in the table of contents. We can't |
|
4066 % just do it on every page because the title pages are numbered 1 and |
|
4067 % 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first two pages |
|
4068 % of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named `1', and |
|
4069 % two named `2'. |
|
4070 \ifpdf \pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi |
|
4071 } |
|
4072 |
|
4073 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in |
|
4074 \newcount\savepageno |
|
4075 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1 |
|
4076 |
|
4077 % Finish up the main text and prepare to read what we've written |
|
4078 % to \tocfile. |
|
4079 % |
|
4080 \def\startcontents#1{% |
|
4081 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should |
|
4082 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain |
|
4083 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro. |
|
4084 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se> |
|
4085 \contentsalignmacro |
|
4086 \immediate\closeout\tocfile |
|
4087 % |
|
4088 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline. |
|
4089 % It is abundantly clear what they are. |
|
4090 \unnumbchapmacro{#1}\def\thischapter{}% |
|
4091 \savepageno = \pageno |
|
4092 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly. |
|
4093 \catcode`\\=0 \catcode`\{=1 \catcode`\}=2 \catcode`\@=11 |
|
4094 % We can't do this, because then an actual ^ in a section |
|
4095 % title fails, e.g., @chapter ^ -- exponentiation. --karl, 9jul97. |
|
4096 %\catcode`\^=7 % to see ^^e4 as \"a etc. juha@piuha.ydi.vtt.fi |
|
4097 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom. |
|
4098 \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length. |
|
4099 % |
|
4100 % Roman numerals for page numbers. |
|
4101 \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi |
|
4102 } |
|
4103 |
|
4104 |
|
4105 % Normal (long) toc. |
|
4106 \def\contents{% |
|
4107 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}% |
|
4108 \openin 1 \jobname.toc |
|
4109 \ifeof 1 \else |
|
4110 \closein 1 |
|
4111 \input \jobname.toc |
|
4112 \fi |
|
4113 \vfill \eject |
|
4114 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect |
|
4115 \pdfmakeoutlines |
|
4116 \endgroup |
|
4117 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno |
|
4118 \global\pageno = \savepageno |
|
4119 } |
|
4120 |
|
4121 % And just the chapters. |
|
4122 \def\summarycontents{% |
|
4123 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}% |
|
4124 % |
|
4125 \let\chapentry = \shortchapentry |
|
4126 \let\appendixentry = \shortappendixentry |
|
4127 \let\unnumbchapentry = \shortunnumberedentry |
|
4128 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers. |
|
4129 \secfonts |
|
4130 \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf |
|
4131 \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt |
|
4132 \rm |
|
4133 \hyphenpenalty = 10000 |
|
4134 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little. |
|
4135 \def\secentry ##1##2##3##4{} |
|
4136 \def\subsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5{} |
|
4137 \def\subsubsecentry ##1##2##3##4##5##6{} |
|
4138 \let\unnumbsecentry = \secentry |
|
4139 \let\unnumbsubsecentry = \subsecentry |
|
4140 \let\unnumbsubsubsecentry = \subsubsecentry |
|
4141 \openin 1 \jobname.toc |
|
4142 \ifeof 1 \else |
|
4143 \closein 1 |
|
4144 \input \jobname.toc |
|
4145 \fi |
|
4146 \vfill \eject |
|
4147 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect |
|
4148 \endgroup |
|
4149 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno |
|
4150 \global\pageno = \savepageno |
|
4151 } |
|
4152 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents |
|
4153 |
|
4154 \ifpdf |
|
4155 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}% |
|
4156 \fi |
|
4157 |
|
4158 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents. |
|
4159 % The first argument is the chapter or section name. |
|
4160 % The last argument is the page number. |
|
4161 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ... |
|
4162 |
|
4163 % Chapters, in the main contents. |
|
4164 \def\chapentry#1#2#3{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#3}} |
|
4165 % |
|
4166 % Chapters, in the short toc. |
|
4167 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings. |
|
4168 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3{% |
|
4169 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#3\egroup}% |
|
4170 } |
|
4171 |
|
4172 % Appendices, in the main contents. |
|
4173 \def\appendixentry#1#2#3{% |
|
4174 \dochapentry{\appendixbox{\putwordAppendix{} #2}\labelspace#1}{#3}} |
|
4175 % |
|
4176 % Appendices, in the short toc. |
|
4177 \let\shortappendixentry = \shortchapentry |
|
4178 |
|
4179 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents. |
|
4180 % The arg is, e.g., `Appendix A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter. |
|
4181 % We could simplify the code here by writing out an \appendixentry |
|
4182 % command in the toc file for appendices, instead of using \chapentry |
|
4183 % for both, but it doesn't seem worth it. |
|
4184 % |
|
4185 \newdimen\shortappendixwidth |
|
4186 % |
|
4187 \def\shortchaplabel#1{% |
|
4188 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the |
|
4189 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts. |
|
4190 % But use \hss just in case. |
|
4191 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after |
|
4192 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.) |
|
4193 \dimen0 = 1em |
|
4194 \hbox to \dimen0{#1\hss}% |
|
4195 } |
|
4196 |
|
4197 % Unnumbered chapters. |
|
4198 \def\unnumbchapentry#1#2#3{\dochapentry{#1}{#3}} |
|
4199 \def\shortunnumberedentry#1#2#3{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#3\egroup}} |
|
4200 |
|
4201 % Sections. |
|
4202 \def\secentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2.#3\labelspace#1}{#4}} |
|
4203 \def\unnumbsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}} |
|
4204 |
|
4205 % Subsections. |
|
4206 \def\subsecentry#1#2#3#4#5{\dosubsecentry{#2.#3.#4\labelspace#1}{#5}} |
|
4207 \def\unnumbsubsecentry#1#2#3#4#5{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#5}} |
|
4208 |
|
4209 % And subsubsections. |
|
4210 \def\subsubsecentry#1#2#3#4#5#6{% |
|
4211 \dosubsubsecentry{#2.#3.#4.#5\labelspace#1}{#6}} |
|
4212 \def\unnumbsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4#5#6{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#6}} |
|
4213 |
|
4214 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels. |
|
4215 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 3pc |
|
4216 |
|
4217 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the |
|
4218 % page number. |
|
4219 % |
|
4220 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters |
|
4221 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty. |
|
4222 \def\dochapentry#1#2{% |
|
4223 \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip |
|
4224 \begingroup |
|
4225 \chapentryfonts |
|
4226 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% |
|
4227 \endgroup |
|
4228 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip |
|
4229 } |
|
4230 |
|
4231 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup |
|
4232 \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent |
|
4233 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% |
|
4234 \endgroup} |
|
4235 |
|
4236 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup |
|
4237 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent |
|
4238 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% |
|
4239 \endgroup} |
|
4240 |
|
4241 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup |
|
4242 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent |
|
4243 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% |
|
4244 \endgroup} |
|
4245 |
|
4246 % Final typesetting of a toc entry; we use the same \entry macro as for |
|
4247 % the index entries, but we want to suppress hyphenation here. (We |
|
4248 % can't do that in the \entry macro, since index entries might consist |
|
4249 % of hyphenated-identifiers-that-do-not-fit-on-a-line-and-nothing-else.) |
|
4250 \def\tocentry#1#2{\begingroup |
|
4251 \vskip 0pt plus1pt % allow a little stretch for the sake of nice page breaks |
|
4252 % Do not use \turnoffactive in these arguments. Since the toc is |
|
4253 % typeset in cmr, characters such as _ would come out wrong; we |
|
4254 % have to do the usual translation tricks. |
|
4255 \entry{#1}{#2}% |
|
4256 \endgroup} |
|
4257 |
|
4258 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title. |
|
4259 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax} |
|
4260 |
|
4261 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}} |
|
4262 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}} |
|
4263 |
|
4264 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm} |
|
4265 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts} |
|
4266 \let\subsecentryfonts = \textfonts |
|
4267 \let\subsubsecentryfonts = \textfonts |
|
4268 |
|
4269 |
|
4270 \message{environments,} |
|
4271 % @foo ... @end foo. |
|
4272 |
|
4273 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}. |
|
4274 % |
|
4275 % Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of |
|
4276 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em. |
|
4277 % |
|
4278 \def\point{$\star$} |
|
4279 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}} |
|
4280 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}} |
|
4281 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}} |
|
4282 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}} |
|
4283 |
|
4284 % The @error{} command. |
|
4285 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit. |
|
4286 % |
|
4287 \newbox\errorbox |
|
4288 % |
|
4289 {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box. |
|
4290 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules |
|
4291 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.) |
|
4292 \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \tensf error\kern-1.5pt} |
|
4293 % |
|
4294 \global\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil |
|
4295 \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right. |
|
4296 \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules. |
|
4297 \vbox{ |
|
4298 \hrule height\dimen2 |
|
4299 \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text. |
|
4300 \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below. |
|
4301 \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right. |
|
4302 \hrule height\dimen2} |
|
4303 \hfil} |
|
4304 % |
|
4305 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox} |
|
4306 |
|
4307 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily. |
|
4308 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works. |
|
4309 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character. |
|
4310 |
|
4311 \def\tex{\begingroup |
|
4312 \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2 |
|
4313 \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6 |
|
4314 \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie |
|
4315 \catcode `\%=14 |
|
4316 \catcode `\+=\other |
|
4317 \catcode `\"=\other |
|
4318 \catcode `\==\other |
|
4319 \catcode `\|=\other |
|
4320 \catcode `\<=\other |
|
4321 \catcode `\>=\other |
|
4322 \escapechar=`\\ |
|
4323 % |
|
4324 \let\b=\ptexb |
|
4325 \let\bullet=\ptexbullet |
|
4326 \let\c=\ptexc |
|
4327 \let\,=\ptexcomma |
|
4328 \let\.=\ptexdot |
|
4329 \let\dots=\ptexdots |
|
4330 \let\equiv=\ptexequiv |
|
4331 \let\!=\ptexexclam |
|
4332 \let\i=\ptexi |
|
4333 \let\indent=\ptexindent |
|
4334 \let\{=\ptexlbrace |
|
4335 \let\+=\tabalign |
|
4336 \let\}=\ptexrbrace |
|
4337 \let\/=\ptexslash |
|
4338 \let\*=\ptexstar |
|
4339 \let\t=\ptext |
|
4340 % |
|
4341 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}% |
|
4342 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}% |
|
4343 \def\@{@}% |
|
4344 \let\Etex=\endgroup} |
|
4345 |
|
4346 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp. |
|
4347 % @lisp does a \begingroup so it can rebind things, |
|
4348 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous). |
|
4349 |
|
4350 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp. |
|
4351 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in |
|
4352 |
|
4353 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other |
|
4354 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't |
|
4355 % have any width. |
|
4356 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf} |
|
4357 |
|
4358 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword |
|
4359 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this |
|
4360 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input |
|
4361 % should produce a line of output anyway. |
|
4362 % |
|
4363 {\obeyspaces % |
|
4364 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}} |
|
4365 |
|
4366 % Define \obeyedspace to be our active space, whatever it is. This is |
|
4367 % for use in \parsearg. |
|
4368 {\sepspaces% |
|
4369 \global\let\obeyedspace= } |
|
4370 |
|
4371 % This space is always present above and below environments. |
|
4372 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt |
|
4373 |
|
4374 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here |
|
4375 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip |
|
4376 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the |
|
4377 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip. |
|
4378 % |
|
4379 \def\aboveenvbreak{{% |
|
4380 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz, q.v. |
|
4381 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else |
|
4382 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip |
|
4383 \endgraf |
|
4384 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount |
|
4385 \removelastskip |
|
4386 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak |
|
4387 % or better ... |
|
4388 \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \else \penalty-50 \fi |
|
4389 \vskip\envskipamount |
|
4390 \fi |
|
4391 \fi |
|
4392 }} |
|
4393 |
|
4394 \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak |
|
4395 |
|
4396 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins. |
|
4397 \let\nonarrowing=\relax |
|
4398 |
|
4399 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around |
|
4400 % environment contents. |
|
4401 \font\circle=lcircle10 |
|
4402 \newdimen\circthick |
|
4403 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner |
|
4404 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip |
|
4405 \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle |
|
4406 % |
|
4407 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth |
|
4408 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}} |
|
4409 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}} |
|
4410 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}} |
|
4411 \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip |
|
4412 \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr |
|
4413 \hskip\rskip}} |
|
4414 \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip |
|
4415 \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr |
|
4416 \hskip\rskip}} |
|
4417 % |
|
4418 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip |
|
4419 |
|
4420 \def\cartouche{% |
|
4421 \par % can't be in the midst of a paragraph. |
|
4422 \begingroup |
|
4423 \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip |
|
4424 \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt %we want these *outside*. |
|
4425 \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip |
|
4426 \advance\cartinner by-\rskip |
|
4427 \cartouter=\hsize |
|
4428 \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either |
|
4429 % side, and for 6pt waste from |
|
4430 % each corner char, and rule thickness |
|
4431 \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip |
|
4432 % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin. |
|
4433 \let\nonarrowing=\comment |
|
4434 \vbox\bgroup |
|
4435 \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt |
|
4436 \carttop |
|
4437 \hbox\bgroup |
|
4438 \hskip\lskip |
|
4439 \vrule\kern3pt |
|
4440 \vbox\bgroup |
|
4441 \hsize=\cartinner |
|
4442 \kern3pt |
|
4443 \begingroup |
|
4444 \baselineskip=\normbskip |
|
4445 \lineskip=\normlskip |
|
4446 \parskip=\normpskip |
|
4447 \vskip -\parskip |
|
4448 \def\Ecartouche{% |
|
4449 \endgroup |
|
4450 \kern3pt |
|
4451 \egroup |
|
4452 \kern3pt\vrule |
|
4453 \hskip\rskip |
|
4454 \egroup |
|
4455 \cartbot |
|
4456 \egroup |
|
4457 \endgroup |
|
4458 }} |
|
4459 |
|
4460 |
|
4461 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants, |
|
4462 % inside a group. |
|
4463 \def\nonfillstart{% |
|
4464 \aboveenvbreak |
|
4465 \inENV % This group ends at the end of the body |
|
4466 \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy |
|
4467 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens. |
|
4468 \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines |
|
4469 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output |
|
4470 \parskip = 0pt |
|
4471 \parindent = 0pt |
|
4472 \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes |
|
4473 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing |
|
4474 % at next level down. |
|
4475 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax |
|
4476 \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing |
|
4477 \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing |
|
4478 \let\exdent=\nofillexdent |
|
4479 \let\nonarrowing=\relax |
|
4480 \fi |
|
4481 } |
|
4482 |
|
4483 % Define the \E... control sequence only if we are inside the particular |
|
4484 % environment, so the error checking in \end will work. |
|
4485 % |
|
4486 % To end an @example-like environment, we first end the paragraph (via |
|
4487 % \afterenvbreak's vertical glue), and then the group. That way we keep |
|
4488 % the zero \parskip that the environments set -- \parskip glue will be |
|
4489 % inserted at the beginning of the next paragraph in the document, after |
|
4490 % the environment. |
|
4491 % |
|
4492 \def\nonfillfinish{\afterenvbreak\endgroup} |
|
4493 |
|
4494 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font. |
|
4495 \def\lisp{\begingroup |
|
4496 \nonfillstart |
|
4497 \let\Elisp = \nonfillfinish |
|
4498 \tt |
|
4499 \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special. |
|
4500 \gobble % eat return |
|
4501 } |
|
4502 |
|
4503 % @example: Same as @lisp. |
|
4504 \def\example{\begingroup \def\Eexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp} |
|
4505 |
|
4506 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts. |
|
4507 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox. |
|
4508 \def\smalllisp{\begingroup |
|
4509 \def\Esmalllisp{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% |
|
4510 \def\Esmallexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% |
|
4511 \smallexamplefonts |
|
4512 \lisp |
|
4513 } |
|
4514 \let\smallexample = \smalllisp |
|
4515 |
|
4516 |
|
4517 % @display: same as @lisp except keep current font. |
|
4518 % |
|
4519 \def\display{\begingroup |
|
4520 \nonfillstart |
|
4521 \let\Edisplay = \nonfillfinish |
|
4522 \gobble |
|
4523 } |
|
4524 % |
|
4525 % @smalldisplay: @display plus smaller fonts. |
|
4526 % |
|
4527 \def\smalldisplay{\begingroup |
|
4528 \def\Esmalldisplay{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% |
|
4529 \smallexamplefonts \rm |
|
4530 \display |
|
4531 } |
|
4532 |
|
4533 % @format: same as @display except don't narrow margins. |
|
4534 % |
|
4535 \def\format{\begingroup |
|
4536 \let\nonarrowing = t |
|
4537 \nonfillstart |
|
4538 \let\Eformat = \nonfillfinish |
|
4539 \gobble |
|
4540 } |
|
4541 % |
|
4542 % @smallformat: @format plus smaller fonts. |
|
4543 % |
|
4544 \def\smallformat{\begingroup |
|
4545 \def\Esmallformat{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% |
|
4546 \smallexamplefonts \rm |
|
4547 \format |
|
4548 } |
|
4549 |
|
4550 % @flushleft (same as @format). |
|
4551 % |
|
4552 \def\flushleft{\begingroup \def\Eflushleft{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\format} |
|
4553 |
|
4554 % @flushright. |
|
4555 % |
|
4556 \def\flushright{\begingroup |
|
4557 \let\nonarrowing = t |
|
4558 \nonfillstart |
|
4559 \let\Eflushright = \nonfillfinish |
|
4560 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill |
|
4561 \gobble |
|
4562 } |
|
4563 |
|
4564 |
|
4565 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart) |
|
4566 % and narrows the margins. |
|
4567 % |
|
4568 \def\quotation{% |
|
4569 \begingroup\inENV %This group ends at the end of the @quotation body |
|
4570 {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip |
|
4571 \parindent=0pt |
|
4572 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're |
|
4573 % doing normal filling. So to avoid extra space below the environment... |
|
4574 \def\Equotation{\parskip = 0pt \nonfillfinish}% |
|
4575 % |
|
4576 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down. |
|
4577 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax |
|
4578 \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing |
|
4579 \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing |
|
4580 \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing |
|
4581 \let\nonarrowing = \relax |
|
4582 \fi |
|
4583 } |
|
4584 |
|
4585 |
|
4586 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>} |
|
4587 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter, |
|
4588 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg: |
|
4589 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org |
|
4590 % |
|
4591 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook. |
|
4592 % |
|
4593 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets |
|
4594 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a |
|
4595 % verbatim line. |
|
4596 \def\dospecials{% |
|
4597 \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&% |
|
4598 \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~% |
|
4599 \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"% |
|
4600 } |
|
4601 % |
|
4602 % [Knuth] p. 380 |
|
4603 \def\uncatcodespecials{% |
|
4604 \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=12}\dospecials} |
|
4605 % |
|
4606 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391 |
|
4607 % Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font |
|
4608 \begingroup |
|
4609 \catcode`\`=\active\gdef`{\relax\lq} |
|
4610 \endgroup |
|
4611 % |
|
4612 % Setup for the @verb command. |
|
4613 % |
|
4614 % Eight spaces for a tab |
|
4615 \begingroup |
|
4616 \catcode`\^^I=\active |
|
4617 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }} |
|
4618 \endgroup |
|
4619 % |
|
4620 \def\setupverb{% |
|
4621 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim |
|
4622 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}% |
|
4623 \catcode`\`=\active |
|
4624 \tabeightspaces |
|
4625 % Respect line breaks, |
|
4626 % print special symbols as themselves, and |
|
4627 % make each space count |
|
4628 % must do in this order: |
|
4629 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces |
|
4630 } |
|
4631 |
|
4632 % Setup for the @verbatim environment |
|
4633 % |
|
4634 % Real tab expansion |
|
4635 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount |
|
4636 % |
|
4637 \def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup} |
|
4638 \begingroup |
|
4639 \catcode`\^^I=\active |
|
4640 \gdef\tabexpand{% |
|
4641 \catcode`\^^I=\active |
|
4642 \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup |
|
4643 \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab |
|
4644 \divide\dimen0 by\tabw |
|
4645 \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw |
|
4646 \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw |
|
4647 \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox |
|
4648 }% |
|
4649 } |
|
4650 \endgroup |
|
4651 \def\setupverbatim{% |
|
4652 % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim |
|
4653 \tt |
|
4654 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}% |
|
4655 \catcode`\`=\active |
|
4656 \tabexpand |
|
4657 % Respect line breaks, |
|
4658 % print special symbols as themselves, and |
|
4659 % make each space count |
|
4660 % must do in this order: |
|
4661 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces |
|
4662 \everypar{\starttabbox}% |
|
4663 } |
|
4664 |
|
4665 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique |
|
4666 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a |
|
4667 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace: |
|
4668 % |
|
4669 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1} |
|
4670 % |
|
4671 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {} |
|
4672 \begingroup |
|
4673 \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=12\catcode`\}=12 |
|
4674 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next] |
|
4675 \endgroup |
|
4676 % |
|
4677 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb} |
|
4678 % |
|
4679 % |
|
4680 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that |
|
4681 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie: |
|
4682 % |
|
4683 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1} |
|
4684 % |
|
4685 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX, |
|
4686 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}': |
|
4687 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'. |
|
4688 % |
|
4689 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx] |
|
4690 %% Include LaTeX hack for completeness -- never know |
|
4691 %% \begingroup |
|
4692 %% \catcode`|=0 \catcode`[=1 |
|
4693 %% \catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=12\catcode`\}=12\catcode`\ =\active |
|
4694 %% \catcode`\\=12|gdef|doverbatim#1@end verbatim[ |
|
4695 %% #1|endgroup|def|Everbatim[]|end[verbatim]] |
|
4696 %% |endgroup |
|
4697 % |
|
4698 \begingroup |
|
4699 \catcode`\ =\active |
|
4700 \obeylines % |
|
4701 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end |
|
4702 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank |
|
4703 % line in the output. |
|
4704 \gdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\end{verbatim}}% |
|
4705 \endgroup |
|
4706 % |
|
4707 \def\verbatim{% |
|
4708 \def\Everbatim{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}% |
|
4709 \begingroup |
|
4710 \nonfillstart |
|
4711 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent |
|
4712 \begingroup\setupverbatim\doverbatim |
|
4713 } |
|
4714 |
|
4715 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment. |
|
4716 % |
|
4717 % Allow normal characters that we make active in the argument (a file name). |
|
4718 \def\verbatiminclude{% |
|
4719 \begingroup |
|
4720 \catcode`\\=\other |
|
4721 \catcode`~=\other |
|
4722 \catcode`^=\other |
|
4723 \catcode`_=\other |
|
4724 \catcode`|=\other |
|
4725 \catcode`<=\other |
|
4726 \catcode`>=\other |
|
4727 \catcode`+=\other |
|
4728 \parsearg\doverbatiminclude |
|
4729 } |
|
4730 \def\setupverbatiminclude{% |
|
4731 \begingroup |
|
4732 \nonfillstart |
|
4733 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent |
|
4734 \begingroup\setupverbatim |
|
4735 } |
|
4736 % |
|
4737 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{% |
|
4738 % Restore active chars for included file. |
|
4739 \endgroup |
|
4740 \begingroup |
|
4741 \let\value=\expandablevalue |
|
4742 \def\thisfile{#1}% |
|
4743 \expandafter\expandafter\setupverbatiminclude\input\thisfile |
|
4744 \endgroup |
|
4745 \nonfillfinish |
|
4746 \endgroup |
|
4747 } |
|
4748 |
|
4749 % @copying ... @end copying. |
|
4750 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later. Many commands won't be |
|
4751 % allowed in this context, but that's ok. |
|
4752 % |
|
4753 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box. |
|
4754 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the |
|
4755 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done |
|
4756 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source |
|
4757 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as |
|
4758 % possible is very desirable. |
|
4759 % |
|
4760 \def\copying{\begingroup |
|
4761 % Define a command to swallow text until we reach `@end copying'. |
|
4762 % \ is the escape char in this texinfo.tex file, so it is the |
|
4763 % delimiter for the command; @ will be the escape char when we read |
|
4764 % it, but that doesn't matter. |
|
4765 \long\def\docopying##1\end copying{\gdef\copyingtext{##1}\enddocopying}% |
|
4766 % |
|
4767 % We must preserve ^^M's in the input file; see \insertcopying below. |
|
4768 \catcode`\^^M = \active |
|
4769 \docopying |
|
4770 } |
|
4771 |
|
4772 % What we do to finish off the copying text. |
|
4773 % |
|
4774 \def\enddocopying{\endgroup\ignorespaces} |
|
4775 |
|
4776 % @insertcopying. Here we must play games with ^^M's. On the one hand, |
|
4777 % we need them to delimit commands such as `@end quotation', so they |
|
4778 % must be active. On the other hand, we certainly don't want every |
|
4779 % end-of-line to be a \par, as would happen with the normal active |
|
4780 % definition of ^^M. On the third hand, two ^^M's in a row should still |
|
4781 % generate a \par. |
|
4782 % |
|
4783 % Our approach is to make ^^M insert a space and a penalty1 normally; |
|
4784 % then it can also check if \lastpenalty=1. If it does, then manually |
|
4785 % do \par. |
|
4786 % |
|
4787 % This messes up the normal definitions of @c[omment], so we redefine |
|
4788 % it. Similarly for @ignore. (These commands are used in the gcc |
|
4789 % manual for man page generation.) |
|
4790 % |
|
4791 % Seems pretty fragile, most line-oriented commands will presumably |
|
4792 % fail, but for the limited use of getting the copying text (which |
|
4793 % should be quite simple) inserted, we can hope it's ok. |
|
4794 % |
|
4795 {\catcode`\^^M=\active % |
|
4796 \gdef\insertcopying{\begingroup % |
|
4797 \parindent = 0pt % looks wrong on title page |
|
4798 \def^^M{% |
|
4799 \ifnum \lastpenalty=1 % |
|
4800 \par % |
|
4801 \else % |
|
4802 \space \penalty 1 % |
|
4803 \fi % |
|
4804 }% |
|
4805 % |
|
4806 % Fix @c[omment] for catcode 13 ^^M's. |
|
4807 \def\c##1^^M{\ignorespaces}% |
|
4808 \let\comment = \c % |
|
4809 % |
|
4810 % Don't bother jumping through all the hoops that \doignore does, it |
|
4811 % would be very hard since the catcodes are already set. |
|
4812 \long\def\ignore##1\end ignore{\ignorespaces}% |
|
4813 % |
|
4814 \copyingtext % |
|
4815 \endgroup}% |
|
4816 } |
|
4817 |
|
4818 \message{defuns,} |
|
4819 % @defun etc. |
|
4820 |
|
4821 % Allow user to change definition object font (\df) internally |
|
4822 \def\setdeffont#1 {\csname DEF#1\endcsname} |
|
4823 |
|
4824 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in |
|
4825 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt |
|
4826 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt |
|
4827 |
|
4828 \newcount\parencount |
|
4829 |
|
4830 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line. |
|
4831 % |
|
4832 \def\activeparens{% |
|
4833 \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active |
|
4834 \catcode`\&=\active |
|
4835 \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active |
|
4836 } |
|
4837 |
|
4838 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars. |
|
4839 \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = ) |
|
4840 |
|
4841 {\activeparens % Now, smart parens don't turn on until &foo (see \amprm) |
|
4842 |
|
4843 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example, |
|
4844 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet, |
|
4845 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence. |
|
4846 \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen |
|
4847 \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack |
|
4848 |
|
4849 \gdef\functionparens{\boldbrax\let&=\amprm\parencount=0 } |
|
4850 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb} |
|
4851 % This is used to turn on special parens |
|
4852 % but make & act ordinary (given that it's active). |
|
4853 \gdef\boldbraxnoamp{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb\let&=\ampnr} |
|
4854 |
|
4855 % Definitions of (, ) and & used in args for functions. |
|
4856 % This is the definition of ( outside of all parentheses. |
|
4857 \gdef\oprm#1 {{\rm\char`\(}#1 \bf \let(=\opnested |
|
4858 \global\advance\parencount by 1 |
|
4859 } |
|
4860 % |
|
4861 % This is the definition of ( when already inside a level of parens. |
|
4862 \gdef\opnested{\char`\(\global\advance\parencount by 1 } |
|
4863 % |
|
4864 \gdef\clrm{% Print a paren in roman if it is taking us back to depth of 0. |
|
4865 % also in that case restore the outer-level definition of (. |
|
4866 \ifnum \parencount=1 {\rm \char `\)}\sl \let(=\oprm \else \char `\) \fi |
|
4867 \global\advance \parencount by -1 } |
|
4868 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards |
|
4869 \gdef\amprm#1 {{\rm\}\let(=\oprm \let)=\clrm\ } |
|
4870 % |
|
4871 \gdef\normalparens{\boldbrax\let&=\ampnr} |
|
4872 } % End of definition inside \activeparens |
|
4873 %% These parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than the |
|
4874 %% contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] |
|
4875 \def\opnr{{\sf\char`\(}\global\advance\parencount by 1 } |
|
4876 \def\clnr{{\sf\char`\)}\global\advance\parencount by -1 } |
|
4877 \let\ampnr = \& |
|
4878 \def\lbrb{{\bf\char`\[}} |
|
4879 \def\rbrb{{\bf\char`\]}} |
|
4880 |
|
4881 % Active &'s sneak into the index arguments, so make sure it's defined. |
|
4882 { |
|
4883 \catcode`& = \active |
|
4884 \global\let& = \ampnr |
|
4885 } |
|
4886 |
|
4887 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args). |
|
4888 % #1 is the function name. |
|
4889 % #2 is the type of definition, such as "Function". |
|
4890 % |
|
4891 \def\defname#1#2{% |
|
4892 % How we'll output the type name. Putting it in brackets helps |
|
4893 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line |
|
4894 % just below it. |
|
4895 \ifempty{#2}% |
|
4896 \def\defnametype{}% |
|
4897 \else |
|
4898 \def\defnametype{[\rm #2]}% |
|
4899 \fi |
|
4900 % |
|
4901 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def... |
|
4902 \dimen2=\leftskip |
|
4903 \advance\dimen2 by -\defbodyindent |
|
4904 % |
|
4905 % Figure out values for the paragraph shape. |
|
4906 \setbox0=\hbox{\hskip \deflastargmargin{\defnametype}}% |
|
4907 \dimen0=\hsize \advance \dimen0 by -\wd0 % compute size for first line |
|
4908 \dimen1=\hsize \advance \dimen1 by -\defargsindent % size for continuations |
|
4909 \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen1 |
|
4910 % |
|
4911 % Output arg 2 ("Function" or some such) but stuck inside a box of |
|
4912 % width 0 so it does not interfere with linebreaking. |
|
4913 \noindent |
|
4914 % |
|
4915 {% Adjust \hsize to exclude the ambient margins, |
|
4916 % so that \rightline will obey them. |
|
4917 \advance \hsize by -\dimen2 |
|
4918 \dimen3 = 0pt % was -1.25pc |
|
4919 \rlap{\rightline{\defnametype\kern\dimen3}}% |
|
4920 }% |
|
4921 % |
|
4922 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint: |
|
4923 \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000 |
|
4924 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent |
|
4925 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent |
|
4926 {\df #1}\enskip % output function name |
|
4927 % \defunargs will be called next to output the arguments, if any. |
|
4928 } |
|
4929 |
|
4930 % Common pieces to start any @def... |
|
4931 % #1 is the \E... control sequence to end the definition (which we define). |
|
4932 % #2 is the \...x control sequence (which our caller defines). |
|
4933 % #3 is the control sequence to process the header, such as \defunheader. |
|
4934 % |
|
4935 \def\parsebodycommon#1#2#3{% |
|
4936 \begingroup\inENV |
|
4937 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak, |
|
4938 % which is there to keep the function description together with its |
|
4939 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we want to allow a |
|
4940 % break after all. Check for penalty 10002 (inserted by |
|
4941 % \defargscommonending) instead of 10000, since the sectioning |
|
4942 % commands insert a \penalty10000, and we don't want to allow a break |
|
4943 % between a section heading and a defun. |
|
4944 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty0 \fi |
|
4945 \medbreak |
|
4946 % |
|
4947 % Define the \E... end token that this defining construct specifies |
|
4948 % so that it will exit this group. |
|
4949 \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}% |
|
4950 % |
|
4951 \parindent=0in |
|
4952 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent |
|
4953 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent |
|
4954 } |
|
4955 |
|
4956 % Common part of the \...x definitions. |
|
4957 % |
|
4958 \def\defxbodycommon{% |
|
4959 % As with \parsebodycommon above, allow line break if we have multiple |
|
4960 % x headers in a row. It's not a great place, though. |
|
4961 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10000 \penalty1000 \fi |
|
4962 % |
|
4963 \begingroup\obeylines |
|
4964 } |
|
4965 |
|
4966 % Process body of @defun, @deffn, @defmac, etc. |
|
4967 % |
|
4968 \def\defparsebody#1#2#3{% |
|
4969 \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% |
|
4970 \def#2{\defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit#3}% |
|
4971 \catcode\equalChar=\active |
|
4972 \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens |
|
4973 \spacesplit#3% |
|
4974 } |
|
4975 |
|
4976 % #1, #2, #3 are the common arguments (see \parsebodycommon above). |
|
4977 % #4, delimited by the space, is the class name. |
|
4978 % |
|
4979 \def\defmethparsebody#1#2#3#4 {% |
|
4980 \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% |
|
4981 \def#2##1 {\defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit{#3{##1}}}% |
|
4982 \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens |
|
4983 % The \empty here prevents misinterpretation of a construct such as |
|
4984 % @deffn {whatever} {Enharmonic comma} |
|
4985 % See comments at \deftpparsebody, although in our case we don't have |
|
4986 % to remove the \empty afterwards, since it is empty. |
|
4987 \spacesplit{#3{#4}}\empty |
|
4988 } |
|
4989 |
|
4990 % Used for @deftypemethod and @deftypeivar. |
|
4991 % #1, #2, #3 are the common arguments (see \defparsebody). |
|
4992 % #4, delimited by a space, is the class name. |
|
4993 % #5 is the method's return type. |
|
4994 % |
|
4995 \def\deftypemethparsebody#1#2#3#4 #5 {% |
|
4996 \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% |
|
4997 \def#2##1 ##2 {\defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit{#3{##1}{##2}}}% |
|
4998 \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens |
|
4999 \spacesplit{#3{#4}{#5}}% |
|
5000 } |
|
5001 |
|
5002 % Used for @deftypeop. The change from \deftypemethparsebody is an |
|
5003 % extra argument at the beginning which is the `category', instead of it |
|
5004 % being the hardwired string `Method' or `Instance Variable'. We have |
|
5005 % to account for this both in the \...x definition and in parsing the |
|
5006 % input at hand. Thus also need a control sequence (passed as #5) for |
|
5007 % the \E... definition to assign the category name to. |
|
5008 % |
|
5009 \def\deftypeopparsebody#1#2#3#4#5 #6 {% |
|
5010 \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% |
|
5011 \def#2##1 ##2 ##3 {\def#4{##1}% |
|
5012 \defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit{#3{##2}{##3}}}% |
|
5013 \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens |
|
5014 \spacesplit{#3{#5}{#6}}% |
|
5015 } |
|
5016 |
|
5017 % For @defop. |
|
5018 \def\defopparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {% |
|
5019 \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% |
|
5020 \def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}% |
|
5021 \defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit{#3{##2}}}% |
|
5022 \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens |
|
5023 \spacesplit{#3{#5}}% |
|
5024 } |
|
5025 |
|
5026 % These parsing functions are similar to the preceding ones |
|
5027 % except that they do not make parens into active characters. |
|
5028 % These are used for "variables" since they have no arguments. |
|
5029 % |
|
5030 \def\defvarparsebody #1#2#3{% |
|
5031 \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% |
|
5032 \def#2{\defxbodycommon \spacesplit#3}% |
|
5033 \catcode\equalChar=\active |
|
5034 \begingroup\obeylines |
|
5035 \spacesplit#3% |
|
5036 } |
|
5037 |
|
5038 % @defopvar. |
|
5039 \def\defopvarparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {% |
|
5040 \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% |
|
5041 \def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}% |
|
5042 \defxbodycommon \spacesplit{#3{##2}}}% |
|
5043 \begingroup\obeylines |
|
5044 \spacesplit{#3{#5}}% |
|
5045 } |
|
5046 |
|
5047 \def\defvrparsebody#1#2#3#4 {% |
|
5048 \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% |
|
5049 \def#2##1 {\defxbodycommon \spacesplit{#3{##1}}}% |
|
5050 \begingroup\obeylines |
|
5051 \spacesplit{#3{#4}}% |
|
5052 } |
|
5053 |
|
5054 % This loses on `@deftp {Data Type} {struct termios}' -- it thinks the |
|
5055 % type is just `struct', because we lose the braces in `{struct |
|
5056 % termios}' when \spacesplit reads its undelimited argument. Sigh. |
|
5057 % \let\deftpparsebody=\defvrparsebody |
|
5058 % |
|
5059 % So, to get around this, we put \empty in with the type name. That |
|
5060 % way, TeX won't find exactly `{...}' as an undelimited argument, and |
|
5061 % won't strip off the braces. |
|
5062 % |
|
5063 \def\deftpparsebody #1#2#3#4 {% |
|
5064 \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}% |
|
5065 \def#2##1 {\defxbodycommon \spacesplit{#3{##1}}}% |
|
5066 \begingroup\obeylines |
|
5067 \spacesplit{\parsetpheaderline{#3{#4}}}\empty |
|
5068 } |
|
5069 |
|
5070 % Fine, but then we have to eventually remove the \empty *and* the |
|
5071 % braces (if any). That's what this does. |
|
5072 % |
|
5073 \def\removeemptybraces\empty#1\relax{#1} |
|
5074 |
|
5075 % After \spacesplit has done its work, this is called -- #1 is the final |
|
5076 % thing to call, #2 the type name (which starts with \empty), and #3 |
|
5077 % (which might be empty) the arguments. |
|
5078 % |
|
5079 \def\parsetpheaderline#1#2#3{% |
|
5080 #1{\removeemptybraces#2\relax}{#3}% |
|
5081 }% |
|
5082 |
|
5083 % Split up #2 (the rest of the input line) at the first space token. |
|
5084 % call #1 with two arguments: |
|
5085 % the first is all of #2 before the space token, |
|
5086 % the second is all of #2 after that space token. |
|
5087 % If #2 contains no space token, all of it is passed as the first arg |
|
5088 % and the second is passed as empty. |
|
5089 % |
|
5090 {\obeylines % |
|
5091 \gdef\spacesplit#1#2^^M{\endgroup\spacesplitx{#1}#2 \relax\spacesplitx}% |
|
5092 \long\gdef\spacesplitx#1#2 #3#4\spacesplitx{% |
|
5093 \ifx\relax #3% |
|
5094 #1{#2}{}% |
|
5095 \else % |
|
5096 #1{#2}{#3#4}% |
|
5097 \fi}% |
|
5098 } |
|
5099 |
|
5100 % Define @defun. |
|
5101 |
|
5102 % This is called to end the arguments processing for all the @def... commands. |
|
5103 % |
|
5104 \def\defargscommonending{% |
|
5105 \interlinepenalty = 10000 |
|
5106 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil |
|
5107 \endgraf |
|
5108 \nobreak\vskip -\parskip |
|
5109 \penalty 10002 % signal to \parsebodycommon. |
|
5110 } |
|
5111 |
|
5112 % This expands the args and terminates the paragraph they comprise. |
|
5113 % |
|
5114 \def\defunargs#1{\functionparens \sl |
|
5115 % Expand, preventing hyphenation at `-' chars. |
|
5116 % Note that groups don't affect changes in \hyphenchar. |
|
5117 % Set the font temporarily and use \font in case \setfont made \tensl a macro. |
|
5118 {\tensl\hyphenchar\font=0}% |
|
5119 #1% |
|
5120 {\tensl\hyphenchar\font=45}% |
|
5121 \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}\fi% |
|
5122 \defargscommonending |
|
5123 } |
|
5124 |
|
5125 \def\deftypefunargs #1{% |
|
5126 % Expand, preventing hyphenation at `-' chars. |
|
5127 % Note that groups don't affect changes in \hyphenchar. |
|
5128 % Use \boldbraxnoamp, not \functionparens, so that & is not special. |
|
5129 \boldbraxnoamp |
|
5130 \tclose{#1}% avoid \code because of side effects on active chars |
|
5131 \defargscommonending |
|
5132 } |
|
5133 |
|
5134 % Do complete processing of one @defun or @defunx line already parsed. |
|
5135 |
|
5136 % @deffn Command forward-char nchars |
|
5137 |
|
5138 \def\deffn{\defmethparsebody\Edeffn\deffnx\deffnheader} |
|
5139 |
|
5140 \def\deffnheader #1#2#3{\doind {fn}{\code{#2}}% |
|
5141 \begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\defunargs{#3}\endgroup % |
|
5142 \catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody |
|
5143 } |
|
5144 |
|
5145 % @defun == @deffn Function |
|
5146 |
|
5147 \def\defun{\defparsebody\Edefun\defunx\defunheader} |
|
5148 |
|
5149 \def\defunheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index |
|
5150 \begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDeffunc}% |
|
5151 \defunargs {#2}\endgroup % |
|
5152 \catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody |
|
5153 } |
|
5154 |
|
5155 % @deftypefun int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar}) |
|
5156 |
|
5157 \def\deftypefun{\defparsebody\Edeftypefun\deftypefunx\deftypefunheader} |
|
5158 |
|
5159 % #1 is the data type. #2 is the name and args. |
|
5160 \def\deftypefunheader #1#2{\deftypefunheaderx{#1}#2 \relax} |
|
5161 % #1 is the data type, #2 the name, #3 the args. |
|
5162 \def\deftypefunheaderx #1#2 #3\relax{% |
|
5163 \doind {fn}{\code{#2}}% Make entry in function index |
|
5164 \begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$.$#2}{\putwordDeftypefun}% |
|
5165 \deftypefunargs {#3}\endgroup % |
|
5166 \catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody |
|
5167 } |
|
5168 |
|
5169 % @deftypefn {Library Function} int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar}) |
|
5170 |
|
5171 \def\deftypefn{\defmethparsebody\Edeftypefn\deftypefnx\deftypefnheader} |
|
5172 |
|
5173 % \defheaderxcond#1\relax$.$ |
|
5174 % puts #1 in @code, followed by a space, but does nothing if #1 is null. |
|
5175 \def\defheaderxcond#1#2$.${\ifx#1\relax\else\code{#1#2} \fi} |
|
5176 |
|
5177 % #1 is the classification. #2 is the data type. #3 is the name and args. |
|
5178 \def\deftypefnheader #1#2#3{\deftypefnheaderx{#1}{#2}#3 \relax} |
|
5179 % #1 is the classification, #2 the data type, #3 the name, #4 the args. |
|
5180 \def\deftypefnheaderx #1#2#3 #4\relax{% |
|
5181 \doind {fn}{\code{#3}}% Make entry in function index |
|
5182 \begingroup |
|
5183 \normalparens % notably, turn off `&' magic, which prevents |
|
5184 % at least some C++ text from working |
|
5185 \defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}{#1}% |
|
5186 \deftypefunargs {#4}\endgroup % |
|
5187 \catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody |
|
5188 } |
|
5189 |
|
5190 % @defmac == @deffn Macro |
|
5191 |
|
5192 \def\defmac{\defparsebody\Edefmac\defmacx\defmacheader} |
|
5193 |
|
5194 \def\defmacheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index |
|
5195 \begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefmac}% |
|
5196 \defunargs {#2}\endgroup % |
|
5197 \catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody |
|
5198 } |
|
5199 |
|
5200 % @defspec == @deffn Special Form |
|
5201 |
|
5202 \def\defspec{\defparsebody\Edefspec\defspecx\defspecheader} |
|
5203 |
|
5204 \def\defspecheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index |
|
5205 \begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefspec}% |
|
5206 \defunargs {#2}\endgroup % |
|
5207 \catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody |
|
5208 } |
|
5209 |
|
5210 % @defop CATEGORY CLASS OPERATION ARG... |
|
5211 % |
|
5212 \def\defop #1 {\def\defoptype{#1}% |
|
5213 \defopparsebody\Edefop\defopx\defopheader\defoptype} |
|
5214 % |
|
5215 \def\defopheader#1#2#3{% |
|
5216 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#2}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% function index entry |
|
5217 \begingroup |
|
5218 \defname{#2}{\defoptype\ \putwordon\ #1}% |
|
5219 \defunargs{#3}% |
|
5220 \endgroup |
|
5221 } |
|
5222 |
|
5223 % @deftypeop CATEGORY CLASS TYPE OPERATION ARG... |
|
5224 % |
|
5225 \def\deftypeop #1 {\def\deftypeopcategory{#1}% |
|
5226 \deftypeopparsebody\Edeftypeop\deftypeopx\deftypeopheader |
|
5227 \deftypeopcategory} |
|
5228 % |
|
5229 % #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the operation name, #4 the args. |
|
5230 \def\deftypeopheader#1#2#3#4{% |
|
5231 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index |
|
5232 \begingroup |
|
5233 \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3} |
|
5234 {\deftypeopcategory\ \putwordon\ \code{#1}}% |
|
5235 \deftypefunargs{#4}% |
|
5236 \endgroup |
|
5237 } |
|
5238 |
|
5239 % @deftypemethod CLASS TYPE METHOD ARG... |
|
5240 % |
|
5241 \def\deftypemethod{% |
|
5242 \deftypemethparsebody\Edeftypemethod\deftypemethodx\deftypemethodheader} |
|
5243 % |
|
5244 % #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the method name, #4 the args. |
|
5245 \def\deftypemethodheader#1#2#3#4{% |
|
5246 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index |
|
5247 \begingroup |
|
5248 \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}{\putwordMethodon\ \code{#1}}% |
|
5249 \deftypefunargs{#4}% |
|
5250 \endgroup |
|
5251 } |
|
5252 |
|
5253 % @deftypeivar CLASS TYPE VARNAME |
|
5254 % |
|
5255 \def\deftypeivar{% |
|
5256 \deftypemethparsebody\Edeftypeivar\deftypeivarx\deftypeivarheader} |
|
5257 % |
|
5258 % #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the variable name. |
|
5259 \def\deftypeivarheader#1#2#3{% |
|
5260 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#3}}{\putwordof\ \code{#1}}% entry in variable index |
|
5261 \begingroup |
|
5262 \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3} |
|
5263 {\putwordInstanceVariableof\ \code{#1}}% |
|
5264 \defvarargs{#3}% |
|
5265 \endgroup |
|
5266 } |
|
5267 |
|
5268 % @defmethod == @defop Method |
|
5269 % |
|
5270 \def\defmethod{\defmethparsebody\Edefmethod\defmethodx\defmethodheader} |
|
5271 % |
|
5272 % #1 is the class name, #2 the method name, #3 the args. |
|
5273 \def\defmethodheader#1#2#3{% |
|
5274 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#2}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index |
|
5275 \begingroup |
|
5276 \defname{#2}{\putwordMethodon\ \code{#1}}% |
|
5277 \defunargs{#3}% |
|
5278 \endgroup |
|
5279 } |
|
5280 |
|
5281 % @defcv {Class Option} foo-class foo-flag |
|
5282 |
|
5283 \def\defcv #1 {\def\defcvtype{#1}% |
|
5284 \defopvarparsebody\Edefcv\defcvx\defcvarheader\defcvtype} |
|
5285 |
|
5286 \def\defcvarheader #1#2#3{% |
|
5287 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#2}}{\putwordof\ \code{#1}}% variable index entry |
|
5288 \begingroup |
|
5289 \defname{#2}{\defcvtype\ \putwordof\ #1}% |
|
5290 \defvarargs{#3}% |
|
5291 \endgroup |
|
5292 } |
|
5293 |
|
5294 % @defivar CLASS VARNAME == @defcv {Instance Variable} CLASS VARNAME |
|
5295 % |
|
5296 \def\defivar{\defvrparsebody\Edefivar\defivarx\defivarheader} |
|
5297 % |
|
5298 \def\defivarheader#1#2#3{% |
|
5299 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#2}}{\putwordof\ \code{#1}}% entry in var index |
|
5300 \begingroup |
|
5301 \defname{#2}{\putwordInstanceVariableof\ #1}% |
|
5302 \defvarargs{#3}% |
|
5303 \endgroup |
|
5304 } |
|
5305 |
|
5306 % @defvar |
|
5307 % First, define the processing that is wanted for arguments of @defvar. |
|
5308 % This is actually simple: just print them in roman. |
|
5309 % This must expand the args and terminate the paragraph they make up |
|
5310 \def\defvarargs #1{\normalparens #1% |
|
5311 \defargscommonending |
|
5312 } |
|
5313 |
|
5314 % @defvr Counter foo-count |
|
5315 |
|
5316 \def\defvr{\defvrparsebody\Edefvr\defvrx\defvrheader} |
|
5317 |
|
5318 \def\defvrheader #1#2#3{\doind {vr}{\code{#2}}% |
|
5319 \begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\defvarargs{#3}\endgroup} |
|
5320 |
|
5321 % @defvar == @defvr Variable |
|
5322 |
|
5323 \def\defvar{\defvarparsebody\Edefvar\defvarx\defvarheader} |
|
5324 |
|
5325 \def\defvarheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index |
|
5326 \begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefvar}% |
|
5327 \defvarargs {#2}\endgroup % |
|
5328 } |
|
5329 |
|
5330 % @defopt == @defvr {User Option} |
|
5331 |
|
5332 \def\defopt{\defvarparsebody\Edefopt\defoptx\defoptheader} |
|
5333 |
|
5334 \def\defoptheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index |
|
5335 \begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefopt}% |
|
5336 \defvarargs {#2}\endgroup % |
|
5337 } |
|
5338 |
|
5339 % @deftypevar int foobar |
|
5340 |
|
5341 \def\deftypevar{\defvarparsebody\Edeftypevar\deftypevarx\deftypevarheader} |
|
5342 |
|
5343 % #1 is the data type. #2 is the name, perhaps followed by text that |
|
5344 % is actually part of the data type, which should not be put into the index. |
|
5345 \def\deftypevarheader #1#2{% |
|
5346 \dovarind#2 \relax% Make entry in variables index |
|
5347 \begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$.$#2}{\putwordDeftypevar}% |
|
5348 \defargscommonending |
|
5349 \endgroup} |
|
5350 \def\dovarind#1 #2\relax{\doind{vr}{\code{#1}}} |
|
5351 |
|
5352 % @deftypevr {Global Flag} int enable |
|
5353 |
|
5354 \def\deftypevr{\defvrparsebody\Edeftypevr\deftypevrx\deftypevrheader} |
|
5355 |
|
5356 \def\deftypevrheader #1#2#3{\dovarind#3 \relax% |
|
5357 \begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}{#1} |
|
5358 \defargscommonending |
|
5359 \endgroup} |
|
5360 |
|
5361 % Now define @deftp |
|
5362 % Args are printed in bold, a slight difference from @defvar. |
|
5363 |
|
5364 \def\deftpargs #1{\bf \defvarargs{#1}} |
|
5365 |
|
5366 % @deftp Class window height width ... |
|
5367 |
|
5368 \def\deftp{\deftpparsebody\Edeftp\deftpx\deftpheader} |
|
5369 |
|
5370 \def\deftpheader #1#2#3{\doind {tp}{\code{#2}}% |
|
5371 \begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\deftpargs{#3}\endgroup} |
|
5372 |
|
5373 % These definitions are used if you use @defunx (etc.) |
|
5374 % anywhere other than immediately after a @defun or @defunx. |
|
5375 % |
|
5376 \def\defcvx#1 {\errmessage{@defcvx in invalid context}} |
|
5377 \def\deffnx#1 {\errmessage{@deffnx in invalid context}} |
|
5378 \def\defivarx#1 {\errmessage{@defivarx in invalid context}} |
|
5379 \def\defmacx#1 {\errmessage{@defmacx in invalid context}} |
|
5380 \def\defmethodx#1 {\errmessage{@defmethodx in invalid context}} |
|
5381 \def\defoptx #1 {\errmessage{@defoptx in invalid context}} |
|
5382 \def\defopx#1 {\errmessage{@defopx in invalid context}} |
|
5383 \def\defspecx#1 {\errmessage{@defspecx in invalid context}} |
|
5384 \def\deftpx#1 {\errmessage{@deftpx in invalid context}} |
|
5385 \def\deftypefnx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypefnx in invalid context}} |
|
5386 \def\deftypefunx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypefunx in invalid context}} |
|
5387 \def\deftypeivarx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypeivarx in invalid context}} |
|
5388 \def\deftypemethodx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypemethodx in invalid context}} |
|
5389 \def\deftypeopx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypeopx in invalid context}} |
|
5390 \def\deftypevarx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypevarx in invalid context}} |
|
5391 \def\deftypevrx#1 {\errmessage{@deftypevrx in invalid context}} |
|
5392 \def\defunx#1 {\errmessage{@defunx in invalid context}} |
|
5393 \def\defvarx#1 {\errmessage{@defvarx in invalid context}} |
|
5394 \def\defvrx#1 {\errmessage{@defvrx in invalid context}} |
|
5395 |
|
5396 |
|
5397 \message{macros,} |
|
5398 % @macro. |
|
5399 |
|
5400 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens, |
|
5401 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX. |
|
5402 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined |
|
5403 \newwrite\macscribble |
|
5404 \def\scanmacro#1{% |
|
5405 \begingroup \newlinechar`\^^M |
|
5406 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex |
|
5407 \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\other \escapechar=`\@ |
|
5408 % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline. |
|
5409 \toks0={#1\endinput}% |
|
5410 \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp |
|
5411 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}% |
|
5412 \immediate\closeout\macscribble |
|
5413 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces |
|
5414 \input \jobname.tmp |
|
5415 \endgroup |
|
5416 } |
|
5417 \else |
|
5418 \def\scanmacro#1{% |
|
5419 \begingroup \newlinechar`\^^M |
|
5420 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex |
|
5421 \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\other \escapechar=`\@ |
|
5422 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces\scantokens{#1\endinput}\endgroup} |
|
5423 \fi |
|
5424 |
|
5425 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters |
|
5426 \newtoks\macname % Macro name |
|
5427 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive? |
|
5428 \def\macrolist{} % List of all defined macros in the form |
|
5429 % \do\macro1\do\macro2... |
|
5430 |
|
5431 % Utility routines. |
|
5432 % Thisdoes \let #1 = #2, except with \csnames. |
|
5433 \def\cslet#1#2{% |
|
5434 \expandafter\expandafter |
|
5435 \expandafter\let |
|
5436 \expandafter\expandafter |
|
5437 \csname#1\endcsname |
|
5438 \csname#2\endcsname} |
|
5439 |
|
5440 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string. |
|
5441 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN). |
|
5442 {\catcode`\@=11 |
|
5443 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }} |
|
5444 \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@} |
|
5445 \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @} |
|
5446 \def\unbrace#1{#1} |
|
5447 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1} |
|
5448 } |
|
5449 |
|
5450 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string. |
|
5451 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3% |
|
5452 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}% |
|
5453 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}% |
|
5454 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}% |
|
5455 } |
|
5456 |
|
5457 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where |
|
5458 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active |
|
5459 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \. |
|
5460 |
|
5461 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is |
|
5462 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro |
|
5463 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro. |
|
5464 |
|
5465 \def\macrobodyctxt{% |
|
5466 \catcode`\~=\other |
|
5467 \catcode`\^=\other |
|
5468 \catcode`\_=\other |
|
5469 \catcode`\|=\other |
|
5470 \catcode`\<=\other |
|
5471 \catcode`\>=\other |
|
5472 \catcode`\+=\other |
|
5473 \catcode`\{=\other |
|
5474 \catcode`\}=\other |
|
5475 \catcode`\@=\other |
|
5476 \catcode`\^^M=\other |
|
5477 \usembodybackslash} |
|
5478 |
|
5479 \def\macroargctxt{% |
|
5480 \catcode`\~=\other |
|
5481 \catcode`\^=\other |
|
5482 \catcode`\_=\other |
|
5483 \catcode`\|=\other |
|
5484 \catcode`\<=\other |
|
5485 \catcode`\>=\other |
|
5486 \catcode`\+=\other |
|
5487 \catcode`\@=\other |
|
5488 \catcode`\\=\other} |
|
5489 |
|
5490 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies. |
|
5491 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N |
|
5492 % where N is the macro parameter number. |
|
5493 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so |
|
5494 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash. |
|
5495 |
|
5496 {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active |
|
5497 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash} |
|
5498 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname} |
|
5499 } |
|
5500 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash} |
|
5501 |
|
5502 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx} |
|
5503 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx} |
|
5504 |
|
5505 \def\macroxxx#1{% |
|
5506 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist |
|
5507 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments |
|
5508 \paramno=0% |
|
5509 \else |
|
5510 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;% |
|
5511 \fi |
|
5512 \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname |
|
5513 \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}% |
|
5514 \else |
|
5515 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax |
|
5516 \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi |
|
5517 \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}% |
|
5518 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1% |
|
5519 % Add the macroname to \macrolist |
|
5520 \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\do}% |
|
5521 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0 |
|
5522 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname\endcsname}% |
|
5523 \fi |
|
5524 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt |
|
5525 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody |
|
5526 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody |
|
5527 \fi} |
|
5528 |
|
5529 \def\unmacro{\parsearg\dounmacro} |
|
5530 \def\dounmacro#1{% |
|
5531 \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname |
|
5532 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}% |
|
5533 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0% |
|
5534 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist: |
|
5535 \begingroup |
|
5536 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax |
|
5537 \let\do\unmacrodo |
|
5538 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}% |
|
5539 \endgroup |
|
5540 \else |
|
5541 \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}% |
|
5542 \fi |
|
5543 } |
|
5544 |
|
5545 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any |
|
5546 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax. |
|
5547 % |
|
5548 \def\unmacrodo#1{% |
|
5549 \ifx#1\relax |
|
5550 % remove this |
|
5551 \else |
|
5552 \noexpand\do \noexpand #1% |
|
5553 \fi |
|
5554 } |
|
5555 |
|
5556 % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a |
|
5557 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by |
|
5558 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed. |
|
5559 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}} |
|
5560 \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs} |
|
5561 \def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}} |
|
5562 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}} |
|
5563 |
|
5564 % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist |
|
5565 % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah |
|
5566 % in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list. |
|
5567 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above). |
|
5568 |
|
5569 % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions. |
|
5570 % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something |
|
5571 % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine |
|
5572 % it to # just before using the token list produced. |
|
5573 % |
|
5574 % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before |
|
5575 % the macro is used. |
|
5576 |
|
5577 \def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}% |
|
5578 \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,} |
|
5579 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{% |
|
5580 \if#1;\let\next=\relax |
|
5581 \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx |
|
5582 \advance\paramno by 1% |
|
5583 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname |
|
5584 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}% |
|
5585 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}% |
|
5586 \fi\next} |
|
5587 |
|
5588 % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. |
|
5589 % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.) |
|
5590 |
|
5591 \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro% |
|
5592 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% |
|
5593 \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro% |
|
5594 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% |
|
5595 |
|
5596 % This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and |
|
5597 % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments. |
|
5598 % Much magic with \expandafter here. |
|
5599 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file |
|
5600 % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group. |
|
5601 \def\defmacro{% |
|
5602 \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars |
|
5603 \ifrecursive |
|
5604 \ifcase\paramno |
|
5605 % 0 |
|
5606 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
|
5607 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% |
|
5608 \or % 1 |
|
5609 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
|
5610 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt |
|
5611 \noexpand\braceorline |
|
5612 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% |
|
5613 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% |
|
5614 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% |
|
5615 \else % many |
|
5616 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
|
5617 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt |
|
5618 \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% |
|
5619 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% |
|
5620 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% |
|
5621 \expandafter\expandafter |
|
5622 \expandafter\xdef |
|
5623 \expandafter\expandafter |
|
5624 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname |
|
5625 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% |
|
5626 \fi |
|
5627 \else |
|
5628 \ifcase\paramno |
|
5629 % 0 |
|
5630 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
|
5631 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% |
|
5632 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% |
|
5633 \or % 1 |
|
5634 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
|
5635 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt |
|
5636 \noexpand\braceorline |
|
5637 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% |
|
5638 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% |
|
5639 \egroup |
|
5640 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% |
|
5641 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% |
|
5642 \else % many |
|
5643 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
|
5644 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt |
|
5645 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% |
|
5646 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% |
|
5647 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% |
|
5648 \expandafter\expandafter |
|
5649 \expandafter\xdef |
|
5650 \expandafter\expandafter |
|
5651 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname |
|
5652 \paramlist{% |
|
5653 \egroup |
|
5654 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% |
|
5655 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% |
|
5656 \fi |
|
5657 \fi} |
|
5658 |
|
5659 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}} |
|
5660 |
|
5661 % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a |
|
5662 % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole |
|
5663 % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence |
|
5664 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg) |
|
5665 \def\braceorline#1{\let\next=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx} |
|
5666 \def\braceorlinexxx{% |
|
5667 \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else |
|
5668 \expandafter\parsearg |
|
5669 \fi \next} |
|
5670 |
|
5671 % We mant to disable all macros during \shipout so that they are not |
|
5672 % expanded by \write. |
|
5673 \def\turnoffmacros{\begingroup \def\do##1{\let\noexpand##1=\relax}% |
|
5674 \edef\next{\macrolist}\expandafter\endgroup\next} |
|
5675 |
|
5676 |
|
5677 % @alias. |
|
5678 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal |
|
5679 % sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing. |
|
5680 \def\alias{\begingroup\obeyspaces\parsearg\aliasxxx} |
|
5681 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax} |
|
5682 \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{\ignoreactivespaces |
|
5683 \edef\next{\global\let\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname=% |
|
5684 \expandafter\noexpand\csname#2\endcsname}% |
|
5685 \expandafter\endgroup\next} |
|
5686 |
|
5687 |
|
5688 \message{cross references,} |
|
5689 % @xref etc. |
|
5690 |
|
5691 \newwrite\auxfile |
|
5692 |
|
5693 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known. |
|
5694 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known. |
|
5695 |
|
5696 % @inforef is relatively simple. |
|
5697 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**} |
|
5698 \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}}, |
|
5699 node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}} |
|
5700 |
|
5701 % @node's job is to define \lastnode. |
|
5702 \def\node{\ENVcheck\parsearg\nodezzz} |
|
5703 \def\nodezzz#1{\nodexxx #1,\finishnodeparse} |
|
5704 \def\nodexxx#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}} |
|
5705 \let\nwnode=\node |
|
5706 \let\lastnode=\relax |
|
5707 |
|
5708 % The sectioning commands (@chapter, etc.) call these. |
|
5709 \def\donoderef{% |
|
5710 \ifx\lastnode\relax\else |
|
5711 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}% |
|
5712 {Ysectionnumberandtype}% |
|
5713 \global\let\lastnode=\relax |
|
5714 \fi |
|
5715 } |
|
5716 \def\unnumbnoderef{% |
|
5717 \ifx\lastnode\relax\else |
|
5718 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}{Ynothing}% |
|
5719 \global\let\lastnode=\relax |
|
5720 \fi |
|
5721 } |
|
5722 \def\appendixnoderef{% |
|
5723 \ifx\lastnode\relax\else |
|
5724 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}% |
|
5725 {Yappendixletterandtype}% |
|
5726 \global\let\lastnode=\relax |
|
5727 \fi |
|
5728 } |
|
5729 |
|
5730 |
|
5731 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point. |
|
5732 % |
|
5733 \newcount\savesfregister |
|
5734 \gdef\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi} |
|
5735 \gdef\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi} |
|
5736 \gdef\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces} |
|
5737 |
|
5738 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an |
|
5739 % anchor), namely NAME-title (the corresponding @chapter/etc. name), |
|
5740 % NAME-pg (the page number), and NAME-snt (section number and type). |
|
5741 % Called from \foonoderef. |
|
5742 % |
|
5743 % We have to set \indexdummies so commands such as @code in a section |
|
5744 % title aren't expanded. It would be nicer not to expand the titles in |
|
5745 % the first place, but there's so many layers that that is hard to do. |
|
5746 % |
|
5747 % Likewise, use \turnoffactive so that punctuation chars such as underscore |
|
5748 % and backslash work in node names. |
|
5749 % |
|
5750 \def\setref#1#2{{% |
|
5751 \atdummies |
|
5752 \pdfmkdest{#1}% |
|
5753 % |
|
5754 \turnoffactive |
|
5755 \dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}% |
|
5756 \dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}% |
|
5757 \dosetq{#1-snt}{#2}% |
|
5758 }} |
|
5759 |
|
5760 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is |
|
5761 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed |
|
5762 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed |
|
5763 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted. |
|
5764 % |
|
5765 \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} |
|
5766 \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} |
|
5767 \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} |
|
5768 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup |
|
5769 \unsepspaces |
|
5770 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}% |
|
5771 \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #3}% |
|
5772 \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual}% |
|
5773 \setbox0=\hbox{\printednodename}% |
|
5774 \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt |
|
5775 % No printed node name was explicitly given. |
|
5776 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax |
|
5777 % Use the node name inside the square brackets. |
|
5778 \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}% |
|
5779 \else |
|
5780 % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside |
|
5781 % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it. |
|
5782 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt |
|
5783 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it. |
|
5784 \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}% |
|
5785 \else |
|
5786 \ifhavexrefs |
|
5787 % We know the real title if we have the xref values. |
|
5788 \def\printednodename{\refx{#1-title}{}}% |
|
5789 \else |
|
5790 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name. |
|
5791 \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}% |
|
5792 \fi% |
|
5793 \fi |
|
5794 \fi |
|
5795 \fi |
|
5796 % |
|
5797 % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not |
|
5798 % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will |
|
5799 % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals |
|
5800 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this |
|
5801 % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it |
|
5802 % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time. |
|
5803 \ifpdf |
|
5804 \leavevmode |
|
5805 \getfilename{#4}% |
|
5806 {\turnoffactive \otherbackslash |
|
5807 \ifnum\filenamelength>0 |
|
5808 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% |
|
5809 goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{#1}% |
|
5810 \else |
|
5811 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% |
|
5812 goto name{#1}% |
|
5813 \fi |
|
5814 }% |
|
5815 \linkcolor |
|
5816 \fi |
|
5817 % |
|
5818 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt |
|
5819 \putwordsection{} ``\printednodename'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}% |
|
5820 \else |
|
5821 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the |
|
5822 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand |
|
5823 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of |
|
5824 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the |
|
5825 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg. |
|
5826 {\turnoffactive \otherbackslash |
|
5827 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for |
|
5828 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be. |
|
5829 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}% |
|
5830 \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi |
|
5831 }% |
|
5832 % output the `[mynode]' via a macro. |
|
5833 \xrefprintnodename\printednodename |
|
5834 % |
|
5835 % But we always want a comma and a space: |
|
5836 ,\space |
|
5837 % |
|
5838 % output the `page 3'. |
|
5839 \turnoffactive \otherbackslash \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}% |
|
5840 \fi |
|
5841 \endlink |
|
5842 \endgroup} |
|
5843 |
|
5844 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref |
|
5845 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily, |
|
5846 % since not square brackets don't work in some documents. Particularly |
|
5847 % one that Bob is working on :). |
|
5848 % |
|
5849 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]} |
|
5850 |
|
5851 % \dosetq is called from \setref to do the actual \write (\iflinks). |
|
5852 % |
|
5853 \def\dosetq#1#2{% |
|
5854 {\let\folio=0% |
|
5855 \edef\next{\write\auxfile{\internalsetq{#1}{#2}}}% |
|
5856 \iflinks \next \fi |
|
5857 }% |
|
5858 } |
|
5859 |
|
5860 % \internalsetq{foo}{page} expands into |
|
5861 % CHARACTERS @xrdef{foo}{...expansion of \page...} |
|
5862 \def\internalsetq#1#2{@xrdef{#1}{\csname #2\endcsname}} |
|
5863 |
|
5864 % Things to be expanded by \internalsetq. |
|
5865 % |
|
5866 \def\Ypagenumber{\folio} |
|
5867 \def\Ytitle{\thissection} |
|
5868 \def\Ynothing{} |
|
5869 \def\Ysectionnumberandtype{% |
|
5870 \ifnum\secno=0 |
|
5871 \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno |
|
5872 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 |
|
5873 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno |
|
5874 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 |
|
5875 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno |
|
5876 \else |
|
5877 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno |
|
5878 \fi\fi\fi |
|
5879 } |
|
5880 |
|
5881 \def\Yappendixletterandtype{% |
|
5882 \ifnum\secno=0 |
|
5883 \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}% |
|
5884 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 |
|
5885 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno |
|
5886 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 |
|
5887 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno |
|
5888 \else |
|
5889 \putwordSection@tie |
|
5890 @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno |
|
5891 \fi\fi\fi |
|
5892 } |
|
5893 |
|
5894 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error |
|
5895 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. |
|
5896 % |
|
5897 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined |
|
5898 \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0. |
|
5899 \else |
|
5900 \def\linenumber{\the\inputlineno:\space} |
|
5901 \fi |
|
5902 |
|
5903 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME. |
|
5904 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward. |
|
5905 % |
|
5906 \def\refx#1#2{% |
|
5907 {% |
|
5908 \indexnofonts |
|
5909 \otherbackslash |
|
5910 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX |
|
5911 \csname X#1\endcsname |
|
5912 }% |
|
5913 \ifx\thisrefX\relax |
|
5914 % If not defined, say something at least. |
|
5915 \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright |
|
5916 \iflinks |
|
5917 \ifhavexrefs |
|
5918 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}% |
|
5919 \else |
|
5920 \ifwarnedxrefs\else |
|
5921 \global\warnedxrefstrue |
|
5922 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}% |
|
5923 \fi |
|
5924 \fi |
|
5925 \fi |
|
5926 \else |
|
5927 % It's defined, so just use it. |
|
5928 \thisrefX |
|
5929 \fi |
|
5930 #2% Output the suffix in any case. |
|
5931 } |
|
5932 |
|
5933 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. |
|
5934 % |
|
5935 \def\xrdef#1{\expandafter\gdef\csname X#1\endcsname} |
|
5936 |
|
5937 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists. |
|
5938 \def\readauxfile{\begingroup |
|
5939 \catcode`\^^@=\other |
|
5940 \catcode`\^^A=\other |
|
5941 \catcode`\^^B=\other |
|
5942 \catcode`\^^C=\other |
|
5943 \catcode`\^^D=\other |
|
5944 \catcode`\^^E=\other |
|
5945 \catcode`\^^F=\other |
|
5946 \catcode`\^^G=\other |
|
5947 \catcode`\^^H=\other |
|
5948 \catcode`\^^K=\other |
|
5949 \catcode`\^^L=\other |
|
5950 \catcode`\^^N=\other |
|
5951 \catcode`\^^P=\other |
|
5952 \catcode`\^^Q=\other |
|
5953 \catcode`\^^R=\other |
|
5954 \catcode`\^^S=\other |
|
5955 \catcode`\^^T=\other |
|
5956 \catcode`\^^U=\other |
|
5957 \catcode`\^^V=\other |
|
5958 \catcode`\^^W=\other |
|
5959 \catcode`\^^X=\other |
|
5960 \catcode`\^^Z=\other |
|
5961 \catcode`\^^[=\other |
|
5962 \catcode`\^^\=\other |
|
5963 \catcode`\^^]=\other |
|
5964 \catcode`\^^^=\other |
|
5965 \catcode`\^^_=\other |
|
5966 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc. |
|
5967 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't |
|
5968 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore, |
|
5969 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^ |
|
5970 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat |
|
5971 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first |
|
5972 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could |
|
5973 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't. |
|
5974 % |
|
5975 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat: |
|
5976 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter |
|
5977 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq. |
|
5978 % |
|
5979 \catcode`\^=\other |
|
5980 % |
|
5981 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but... |
|
5982 \catcode`\~=\other |
|
5983 \catcode`\[=\other |
|
5984 \catcode`\]=\other |
|
5985 \catcode`\"=\other |
|
5986 \catcode`\_=\other |
|
5987 \catcode`\|=\other |
|
5988 \catcode`\<=\other |
|
5989 \catcode`\>=\other |
|
5990 \catcode`\$=\other |
|
5991 \catcode`\#=\other |
|
5992 \catcode`\&=\other |
|
5993 \catcode`\%=\other |
|
5994 \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off |
|
5995 % |
|
5996 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters |
|
5997 {% |
|
5998 \count 1=128 |
|
5999 \def\loop{% |
|
6000 \catcode\count 1=\other |
|
6001 \advance\count 1 by 1 |
|
6002 \ifnum \count 1<256 \loop \fi |
|
6003 }% |
|
6004 }% |
|
6005 % |
|
6006 % Turn off \ as an escape so we do not lose on |
|
6007 % entries which were dumped with control sequences in their names. |
|
6008 % For example, @xrdef{$\leq $-fun}{page ...} made by @defun ^^ |
|
6009 % Reference to such entries still does not work the way one would wish, |
|
6010 % but at least they do not bomb out when the aux file is read in. |
|
6011 \catcode`\\=\other |
|
6012 % |
|
6013 % @ is our escape character in .aux files. |
|
6014 \catcode`\{=1 |
|
6015 \catcode`\}=2 |
|
6016 \catcode`\@=0 |
|
6017 % |
|
6018 \openin 1 \jobname.aux |
|
6019 \ifeof 1 \else |
|
6020 \closein 1 |
|
6021 \input \jobname.aux |
|
6022 \global\havexrefstrue |
|
6023 \fi |
|
6024 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit. |
|
6025 \openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux |
|
6026 \endgroup} |
|
6027 |
|
6028 |
|
6029 % Footnotes. |
|
6030 |
|
6031 \newcount \footnoteno |
|
6032 |
|
6033 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is |
|
6034 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a |
|
6035 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is |
|
6036 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a |
|
6037 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.) |
|
6038 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 } |
|
6039 |
|
6040 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only. |
|
6041 \let\footnotestyle=\comment |
|
6042 |
|
6043 \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote |
|
6044 |
|
6045 {\catcode `\@=11 |
|
6046 % |
|
6047 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain. |
|
6048 \gdef\footnote{% |
|
6049 \let\indent=\ptexindent |
|
6050 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne |
|
6051 \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}% |
|
6052 % |
|
6053 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the |
|
6054 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number. |
|
6055 \let\@sf\empty |
|
6056 \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi |
|
6057 % |
|
6058 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number. |
|
6059 \unskip |
|
6060 \thisfootno\@sf |
|
6061 \dofootnote |
|
6062 }% |
|
6063 |
|
6064 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the |
|
6065 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general. |
|
6066 % |
|
6067 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset and anything else that uses |
|
6068 % \parseargline fail inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when |
|
6069 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96. |
|
6070 % |
|
6071 % The start of the footnote looks usually like this: |
|
6072 \gdef\startfootins{\insert\footins\bgroup} |
|
6073 % |
|
6074 % ... but this macro is redefined inside @multitable. |
|
6075 % |
|
6076 \gdef\dofootnote{% |
|
6077 \startfootins |
|
6078 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the |
|
6079 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment. |
|
6080 % So reset some parameters. |
|
6081 \hsize=\pagewidth |
|
6082 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty |
|
6083 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes |
|
6084 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox |
|
6085 \floatingpenalty\@MM |
|
6086 \leftskip\z@skip |
|
6087 \rightskip\z@skip |
|
6088 \spaceskip\z@skip |
|
6089 \xspaceskip\z@skip |
|
6090 \parindent\defaultparindent |
|
6091 % |
|
6092 \smallfonts \rm |
|
6093 % |
|
6094 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears |
|
6095 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use |
|
6096 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote |
|
6097 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style). |
|
6098 \let\noindent = \relax |
|
6099 % |
|
6100 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the |
|
6101 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph. |
|
6102 \everypar = {\hang}% |
|
6103 \textindent{\thisfootno}% |
|
6104 % |
|
6105 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this |
|
6106 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it |
|
6107 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote. |
|
6108 \footstrut |
|
6109 \futurelet\next\fo@t |
|
6110 } |
|
6111 }%end \catcode `\@=11 |
|
6112 |
|
6113 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should |
|
6114 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the |
|
6115 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would |
|
6116 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main |
|
6117 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change). |
|
6118 % |
|
6119 \def\|{% |
|
6120 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode. |
|
6121 \leavevmode |
|
6122 % |
|
6123 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output. |
|
6124 \vadjust{% |
|
6125 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current |
|
6126 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record. |
|
6127 \vskip-\baselineskip |
|
6128 % |
|
6129 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So |
|
6130 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin. |
|
6131 \llap{% |
|
6132 % |
|
6133 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'. |
|
6134 \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt |
|
6135 % |
|
6136 % This is the space between the bar and the text. |
|
6137 \hskip 12pt |
|
6138 }% |
|
6139 }% |
|
6140 } |
|
6141 |
|
6142 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles |
|
6143 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided |
|
6144 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin). |
|
6145 % |
|
6146 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt} |
|
6147 |
|
6148 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this. |
|
6149 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain. |
|
6150 % |
|
6151 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image |
|
6152 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get |
|
6153 % undone and the next image would fail. |
|
6154 \openin 1 = epsf.tex |
|
6155 \ifeof 1 \else |
|
6156 \closein 1 |
|
6157 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in |
|
6158 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan). |
|
6159 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }% |
|
6160 \input epsf.tex |
|
6161 \fi |
|
6162 % |
|
6163 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex. |
|
6164 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf |
|
6165 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to |
|
6166 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get |
|
6167 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.} |
|
6168 % |
|
6169 \def\image#1{% |
|
6170 \ifx\epsfbox\undefined |
|
6171 \ifwarnednoepsf \else |
|
6172 \errhelp = \noepsfhelp |
|
6173 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}% |
|
6174 \global\warnednoepsftrue |
|
6175 \fi |
|
6176 \else |
|
6177 \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish |
|
6178 \fi |
|
6179 } |
|
6180 % |
|
6181 % Arguments to @image: |
|
6182 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension. |
|
6183 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height. |
|
6184 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text. |
|
6185 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension. |
|
6186 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff. |
|
6187 \newif\ifimagevmode |
|
6188 \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup |
|
6189 \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example |
|
6190 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names |
|
6191 % If the image is by itself, center it. |
|
6192 \ifvmode |
|
6193 \imagevmodetrue |
|
6194 \nobreak\bigskip |
|
6195 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert |
|
6196 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space |
|
6197 % above and below. |
|
6198 \nobreak\vskip\parskip |
|
6199 \nobreak |
|
6200 \line\bgroup\hss |
|
6201 \fi |
|
6202 % |
|
6203 % Output the image. |
|
6204 \ifpdf |
|
6205 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}% |
|
6206 \else |
|
6207 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure. |
|
6208 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi |
|
6209 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi |
|
6210 \epsfbox{#1.eps}% |
|
6211 \fi |
|
6212 % |
|
6213 \ifimagevmode \hss \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image |
|
6214 \endgroup} |
|
6215 |
|
6216 |
|
6217 \message{localization,} |
|
6218 % and i18n. |
|
6219 |
|
6220 % @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after |
|
6221 % @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything |
|
6222 % properly. Single argument is the language abbreviation. |
|
6223 % It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file here. |
|
6224 % |
|
6225 \def\documentlanguage{\parsearg\dodocumentlanguage} |
|
6226 \def\dodocumentlanguage#1{% |
|
6227 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX. |
|
6228 % Read the file if it exists. |
|
6229 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex |
|
6230 \ifeof1 |
|
6231 \errhelp = \nolanghelp |
|
6232 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}% |
|
6233 \let\temp = \relax |
|
6234 \else |
|
6235 \def\temp{\input txi-#1.tex }% |
|
6236 \fi |
|
6237 \temp |
|
6238 \endgroup |
|
6239 } |
|
6240 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or |
|
6241 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory |
|
6242 should work if nowhere else does.} |
|
6243 |
|
6244 |
|
6245 % @documentencoding should change something in TeX eventually, most |
|
6246 % likely, but for now just recognize it. |
|
6247 \let\documentencoding = \comment |
|
6248 |
|
6249 |
|
6250 % Page size parameters. |
|
6251 % |
|
6252 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt |
|
6253 |
|
6254 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt |
|
6255 \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt |
|
6256 \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt |
|
6257 |
|
6258 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages. |
|
6259 \vbadness = 10000 |
|
6260 |
|
6261 % Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either. |
|
6262 \hbadness = 2000 |
|
6263 |
|
6264 % Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans. |
|
6265 \widowpenalty=10000 |
|
6266 \clubpenalty=10000 |
|
6267 |
|
6268 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're |
|
6269 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of |
|
6270 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on |
|
6271 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set. |
|
6272 % |
|
6273 \def\setemergencystretch{% |
|
6274 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined |
|
6275 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway. |
|
6276 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}% |
|
6277 \else |
|
6278 \emergencystretch = .15\hsize |
|
6279 \fi |
|
6280 } |
|
6281 |
|
6282 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth; 3) voffset; |
|
6283 % 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip; 7) physical page height; 8) |
|
6284 % physical page width. |
|
6285 % |
|
6286 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define |
|
6287 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip. |
|
6288 % |
|
6289 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{% |
|
6290 \voffset = #3\relax |
|
6291 \topskip = #6\relax |
|
6292 \splittopskip = \topskip |
|
6293 % |
|
6294 \vsize = #1\relax |
|
6295 \advance\vsize by \topskip |
|
6296 \outervsize = \vsize |
|
6297 \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin |
|
6298 \pageheight = \vsize |
|
6299 % |
|
6300 \hsize = #2\relax |
|
6301 \outerhsize = \hsize |
|
6302 \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in |
|
6303 \pagewidth = \hsize |
|
6304 % |
|
6305 \normaloffset = #4\relax |
|
6306 \bindingoffset = #5\relax |
|
6307 % |
|
6308 \ifpdf |
|
6309 \pdfpageheight #7\relax |
|
6310 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax |
|
6311 \fi |
|
6312 % |
|
6313 \setleading{\textleading} |
|
6314 % |
|
6315 \parindent = \defaultparindent |
|
6316 \setemergencystretch |
|
6317 } |
|
6318 |
|
6319 % @letterpaper (the default). |
|
6320 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 |
|
6321 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt |
|
6322 \textleading = 13.2pt |
|
6323 % |
|
6324 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even. |
|
6325 \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}% |
|
6326 {\voffset}{.25in}% |
|
6327 {\bindingoffset}{36pt}% |
|
6328 {11in}{8.5in}% |
|
6329 }} |
|
6330 |
|
6331 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.5 (or so) format. |
|
6332 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1 |
|
6333 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt |
|
6334 \textleading = 12pt |
|
6335 % |
|
6336 \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}% |
|
6337 {\voffset}{.25in}% |
|
6338 {\bindingoffset}{16pt}% |
|
6339 {9.25in}{7in}% |
|
6340 % |
|
6341 \lispnarrowing = 0.3in |
|
6342 \tolerance = 700 |
|
6343 \hfuzz = 1pt |
|
6344 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt |
|
6345 \defbodyindent = .5cm |
|
6346 }} |
|
6347 |
|
6348 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper. |
|
6349 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 |
|
6350 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt |
|
6351 \textleading = 13.2pt |
|
6352 % |
|
6353 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050 |
|
6354 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm. |
|
6355 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust |
|
6356 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then |
|
6357 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in |
|
6358 % your texinfo source file like this: |
|
6359 % @tex |
|
6360 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm |
|
6361 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm |
|
6362 % @end tex |
|
6363 \internalpagesizes{51\baselineskip}{160mm} |
|
6364 {\voffset}{\hoffset}% |
|
6365 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% |
|
6366 {297mm}{210mm}% |
|
6367 % |
|
6368 \tolerance = 700 |
|
6369 \hfuzz = 1pt |
|
6370 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt |
|
6371 \defbodyindent = 5mm |
|
6372 }} |
|
6373 |
|
6374 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper. |
|
6375 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000. |
|
6376 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small. |
|
6377 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1 |
|
6378 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt |
|
6379 \textleading = 12.5pt |
|
6380 % |
|
6381 \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}% |
|
6382 {\voffset}{\hoffset}% |
|
6383 {\bindingoffset}{8pt}% |
|
6384 {210mm}{148mm}% |
|
6385 % |
|
6386 \lispnarrowing = 0.2in |
|
6387 \tolerance = 800 |
|
6388 \hfuzz = 1.2pt |
|
6389 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt |
|
6390 \defbodyindent = 2mm |
|
6391 \tableindent = 12mm |
|
6392 }} |
|
6393 |
|
6394 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper. |
|
6395 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1 |
|
6396 \afourpaper |
|
6397 \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}% |
|
6398 {\voffset}{4.6mm}% |
|
6399 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% |
|
6400 {297mm}{210mm}% |
|
6401 % |
|
6402 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper. |
|
6403 \globaldefs = 0 |
|
6404 }} |
|
6405 |
|
6406 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format. |
|
6407 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1 |
|
6408 \afourpaper |
|
6409 \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}% |
|
6410 {\voffset}{-2.95mm}% |
|
6411 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% |
|
6412 {297mm}{210mm}% |
|
6413 \globaldefs = 0 |
|
6414 }} |
|
6415 |
|
6416 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH] |
|
6417 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip, |
|
6418 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow. |
|
6419 % |
|
6420 \def\pagesizes{\parsearg\pagesizesxxx} |
|
6421 \def\pagesizesxxx#1{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish} |
|
6422 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{% |
|
6423 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi |
|
6424 \globaldefs = 1 |
|
6425 % |
|
6426 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt |
|
6427 \setleading{\textleading}% |
|
6428 % |
|
6429 \dimen0 = #1 |
|
6430 \advance\dimen0 by \voffset |
|
6431 % |
|
6432 \dimen2 = \hsize |
|
6433 \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset |
|
6434 % |
|
6435 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}% |
|
6436 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}% |
|
6437 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% |
|
6438 {\dimen0}{\dimen2}% |
|
6439 }} |
|
6440 |
|
6441 % Set default to letter. |
|
6442 % |
|
6443 \letterpaper |
|
6444 |
|
6445 |
|
6446 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.} |
|
6447 |
|
6448 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text. |
|
6449 \catcode`\"=\other |
|
6450 \catcode`\~=\other |
|
6451 \catcode`\^=\other |
|
6452 \catcode`\_=\other |
|
6453 \catcode`\|=\other |
|
6454 \catcode`\<=\other |
|
6455 \catcode`\>=\other |
|
6456 \catcode`\+=\other |
|
6457 \catcode`\$=\other |
|
6458 \def\normaldoublequote{"} |
|
6459 \def\normaltilde{~} |
|
6460 \def\normalcaret{^} |
|
6461 \def\normalunderscore{_} |
|
6462 \def\normalverticalbar{|} |
|
6463 \def\normalless{<} |
|
6464 \def\normalgreater{>} |
|
6465 \def\normalplus{+} |
|
6466 \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix |
|
6467 |
|
6468 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in ttfont |
|
6469 % where it can probably just be output, and another way in other fonts, |
|
6470 % where something hairier probably needs to be done. |
|
6471 % |
|
6472 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print |
|
6473 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero |
|
6474 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all |
|
6475 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter. |
|
6476 % |
|
6477 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi} |
|
6478 |
|
6479 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches |
|
6480 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from |
|
6481 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway |
|
6482 % this is not a problem. |
|
6483 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi} |
|
6484 |
|
6485 % Turn off all special characters except @ |
|
6486 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary). |
|
6487 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can |
|
6488 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text. |
|
6489 |
|
6490 \catcode`\"=\active |
|
6491 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}} |
|
6492 \let"=\activedoublequote |
|
6493 \catcode`\~=\active |
|
6494 \def~{{\tt\char126}} |
|
6495 \chardef\hat=`\^ |
|
6496 \catcode`\^=\active |
|
6497 \def^{{\tt \hat}} |
|
6498 |
|
6499 \catcode`\_=\active |
|
6500 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_} |
|
6501 % Subroutine for the previous macro. |
|
6502 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em } |
|
6503 |
|
6504 \catcode`\|=\active |
|
6505 \def|{{\tt\char124}} |
|
6506 \chardef \less=`\< |
|
6507 \catcode`\<=\active |
|
6508 \def<{{\tt \less}} |
|
6509 \chardef \gtr=`\> |
|
6510 \catcode`\>=\active |
|
6511 \def>{{\tt \gtr}} |
|
6512 \catcode`\+=\active |
|
6513 \def+{{\tt \char 43}} |
|
6514 \catcode`\$=\active |
|
6515 \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix |
|
6516 |
|
6517 % Set up an active definition for =, but don't enable it most of the time. |
|
6518 {\catcode`\==\active |
|
6519 \global\def={{\tt \char 61}}} |
|
6520 |
|
6521 \catcode`+=\active |
|
6522 \catcode`\_=\active |
|
6523 |
|
6524 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file |
|
6525 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line. |
|
6526 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on. |
|
6527 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file. |
|
6528 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other} |
|
6529 |
|
6530 \catcode`\@=0 |
|
6531 |
|
6532 % \rawbackslashxx outputs one backslash character in current font, |
|
6533 % as in \char`\\. |
|
6534 \global\chardef\rawbackslashxx=`\\ |
|
6535 |
|
6536 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \rawbackslashxx. |
|
6537 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with |
|
6538 % catcode other. |
|
6539 {\catcode`\\=\active |
|
6540 @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@rawbackslashxx} |
|
6541 @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash} |
|
6542 } |
|
6543 |
|
6544 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other. |
|
6545 {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\}} |
|
6546 |
|
6547 % \normalbackslash outputs one backslash in fixed width font. |
|
6548 \def\normalbackslash{{\tt\rawbackslashxx}} |
|
6549 |
|
6550 \catcode`\\=\active |
|
6551 |
|
6552 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters |
|
6553 % even after parsing them. |
|
6554 @def@turnoffactive{% |
|
6555 @let"=@normaldoublequote |
|
6556 @let\=@realbackslash |
|
6557 @let~=@normaltilde |
|
6558 @let^=@normalcaret |
|
6559 @let_=@normalunderscore |
|
6560 @let|=@normalverticalbar |
|
6561 @let<=@normalless |
|
6562 @let>=@normalgreater |
|
6563 @let+=@normalplus |
|
6564 @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix |
|
6565 } |
|
6566 |
|
6567 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of |
|
6568 % the literal character `\'. (Thus, \ is not expandable when this is in |
|
6569 % effect.) |
|
6570 % |
|
6571 @def@normalturnoffactive{@turnoffactive @let\=@normalbackslash} |
|
6572 |
|
6573 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily. |
|
6574 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash. |
|
6575 @otherifyactive |
|
6576 |
|
6577 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up. |
|
6578 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing |
|
6579 % a backslash. |
|
6580 % |
|
6581 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash} |
|
6582 @global@let\ = @eatinput |
|
6583 |
|
6584 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then |
|
6585 % the first `\{ in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix |
|
6586 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur. |
|
6587 % Also back turn on active characters that might appear in the input |
|
6588 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format. |
|
6589 % |
|
6590 @gdef@fixbackslash{% |
|
6591 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi |
|
6592 @catcode`+=@active |
|
6593 @catcode`@_=@active |
|
6594 } |
|
6595 |
|
6596 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages. |
|
6597 @escapechar = `@@ |
|
6598 |
|
6599 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special. |
|
6600 @catcode`@& = @other |
|
6601 @catcode`@# = @other |
|
6602 @catcode`@% = @other |
|
6603 |
|
6604 @c Set initial fonts. |
|
6605 @textfonts |
|
6606 @rm |
|
6607 |
|
6608 |
|
6609 @c Local variables: |
|
6610 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) |
|
6611 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message" |
|
6612 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{" |
|
6613 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" |
|
6614 @c time-stamp-end: "}" |
|
6615 @c End: |